aae09bfc82f1f736f779a13ad6b1945c69a7f986
[gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi
1 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2016 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
2 @c This is part of the GCC manual.
3 @c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
4
5 @node Target Macros
6 @chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
7 @cindex machine description macros
8 @cindex target description macros
9 @cindex macros, target description
10 @cindex @file{tm.h} macros
11
12 In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
13 includes a C header file conventionally given the name
14 @file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
15 The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
16 about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
17 @file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
18 @file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
19 @file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
20 source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
21 containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
22 machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
23 if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
24 through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
25
26 @menu
27 * Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
28 * Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
29 * Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
30 * Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
31 * Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
32 * Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
33 * Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
34 * Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
35 * Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
36 * Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
37 * Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
38 * Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
39 * Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
40 * Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
41 * Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
42 * Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
43 * Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
44 * Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
45 * PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
46 * Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
47 * Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
48 * Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
49 * Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
50 * Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
51 * Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
52 * MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
53 * PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
54 * C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
55 * Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
56 * Misc:: Everything else.
57 @end menu
58
59 @node Target Structure
60 @section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
61 @cindex target hooks
62 @cindex target functions
63
64 @deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
65 The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
66 which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
67 machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
68 @file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
69 used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
70 for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
71 macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
72 @smallexample
73 #include "target.h"
74 #include "target-def.h"
75
76 /* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
77
78 #undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
79 #define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
80
81 struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
82 @end smallexample
83 @end deftypevar
84
85 Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
86 form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
87 ``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
88 from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
89 @code{targetm} structure.
90
91 Similarly, there is a @code{targetcm} variable for hooks that are
92 specific to front ends for C-family languages, documented as ``C
93 Target Hook''. This is declared in @file{c-family/c-target.h}, the
94 initializer @code{TARGETCM_INITIALIZER} in
95 @file{c-family/c-target-def.h}. If targets initialize @code{targetcm}
96 themselves, they should set @code{target_has_targetcm=yes} in
97 @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default definition is used.
98
99 Similarly, there is a @code{targetm_common} variable for hooks that
100 are shared between the compiler driver and the compilers proper,
101 documented as ``Common Target Hook''. This is declared in
102 @file{common/common-target.h}, the initializer
103 @code{TARGETM_COMMON_INITIALIZER} in
104 @file{common/common-target-def.h}. If targets initialize
105 @code{targetm_common} themselves, they should set
106 @code{target_has_targetm_common=yes} in @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a
107 default definition is used.
108
109 @node Driver
110 @section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
111 @cindex driver
112 @cindex controlling the compilation driver
113
114 @c prevent bad page break with this line
115 You can control the compilation driver.
116
117 @defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
118 A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
119 initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
120
121 The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
122 default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
123 choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
124 applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
125 options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
126 using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
127
128 This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
129 options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
130 that the other specs are easier to write.
131
132 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
133 @end defmac
134
135 @defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
136 A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
137 @option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
138 for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
139 outermost pair of surrounding braces.
140
141 The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
142 the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
143 to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
144 @samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
145 everywhere it occurs.
146
147 The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
148 default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
149 the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
150
151 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
152 @end defmac
153
154 @defmac CPP_SPEC
155 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
156 pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
157 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
158
159 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
160 @end defmac
161
162 @defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
163 This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
164 than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
165 @code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
166 @end defmac
167
168 @defmac CC1_SPEC
169 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
170 pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
171 front ends.
172 It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
173 for GCC to pass to front ends.
174
175 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
176 @end defmac
177
178 @defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
179 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
180 pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
181 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
182
183 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
184 Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
185 @code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
186 CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
187 @end defmac
188
189 @defmac ASM_SPEC
190 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
191 pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
192 you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
193 See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
194
195 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
196 @end defmac
197
198 @defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
199 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
200 run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
201 Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
202 an example of this.
203
204 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
205 @end defmac
206
207 @defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
208 Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
209 an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
210 read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
211 output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
212 @option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
213
214 If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
215 standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
216 cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
217 see @file{mips.h} for instance.
218 @end defmac
219
220 @defmac LINK_SPEC
221 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
222 pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
223 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
224
225 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
226 @end defmac
227
228 @defmac LIB_SPEC
229 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
230 between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
231 command given to the linker.
232
233 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
234 loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
235 @end defmac
236
237 @defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
238 Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
239 how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
240 linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
241 the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
242
243 If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
244 passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
245 @end defmac
246
247 @defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
248 By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
249 @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
250 instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
251 depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
252 @option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
253 targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
254 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
255 driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
256 line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
257 @end defmac
258
259 @defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
260 A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
261 mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
262 generated that uses @option{--as-needed} or equivalent options and the
263 shared @file{libgcc} in place of the
264 static exception handler library, when linking without any of
265 @code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
266 @end defmac
267
268 @defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
269 If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
270 When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
271 the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
272 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
273 @end defmac
274
275 @defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
276 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
277 difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
278 the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
279
280 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
281 standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
282 @end defmac
283
284 @defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
285 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
286 difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
287 the very end of the command given to the linker.
288
289 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
290 @end defmac
291
292 @defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
293 GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
294 However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
295 models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
296 @code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
297 blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
298 default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
299 @code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
300 @end defmac
301
302 @defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
303 Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
304 configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
305 et al, within sysroot+suffix.
306 @end defmac
307
308 @defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
309 Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
310 GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
311 updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
312 usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
313 @end defmac
314
315 @defmac EXTRA_SPECS
316 Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
317 @file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
318 @code{CC1_SPEC}.
319
320 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
321 containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
322 string constant that provides the specification.
323
324 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
325
326 @code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
327 related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
328 to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
329 these definitions.
330
331 For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
332 define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
333 used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
334 used.
335
336 The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
337
338 @smallexample
339 #define EXTRA_SPECS \
340 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
341
342 #define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
343 @end smallexample
344
345 The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
346 @smallexample
347 #undef CPP_SPEC
348 #define CPP_SPEC \
349 "%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
350 %@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
351 %@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
352 %@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
353
354 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
355 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
356 @end smallexample
357
358 while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
359 @code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
360
361 @smallexample
362 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
363 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
364 @end smallexample
365 @end defmac
366
367 @defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
368 Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
369 @file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
370 the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
371 @end defmac
372
373 @defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
374 The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
375 By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
376 @end defmac
377
378 @defmac POST_LINK_SPEC
379 Define this macro to add additional steps to be executed after linker.
380 The default value of this macro is empty string.
381 @end defmac
382
383 @defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
384 A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
385 linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
386 change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
387 define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
388 line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
389 the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
390 @code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
391 @end defmac
392
393 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALWAYS_STRIP_DOTDOT
394 True if @file{..} components should always be removed from directory names computed relative to GCC's internal directories, false (default) if such components should be preserved and directory names containing them passed to other tools such as the linker.
395 @end deftypevr
396
397 @defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
398 Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
399 string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
400 target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
401 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
402
403 Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
404 the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
405 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
406 @xref{Target Fragment}.
407 @end defmac
408
409 @defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
410 Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
411 a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
412 indicates an absolute file name.
413 @end defmac
414
415 @defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
416 If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
417 @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
418 when the compiler is built as a cross
419 compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
420 to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.ac}.
421 @end defmac
422
423 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
424 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
425 standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
426 try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
427 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
428 is built as a cross compiler.
429 @end defmac
430
431 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
432 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
433 standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
434 when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
435 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
436 is built as a cross compiler.
437 @end defmac
438
439 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
440 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
441 standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
442 default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
443 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
444 is built as a cross compiler.
445 @end defmac
446
447 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
448 If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
449 standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
450 compiler is built as a cross compiler.
451 @end defmac
452
453 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
454 If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
455 standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
456 cross compiler.
457 @end defmac
458
459 @defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
460 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
461 variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
462 loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
463 initialize the necessary environment variables.
464 @end defmac
465
466 @defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
467 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
468 standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
469 try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
470 comes before @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR} (set in
471 @file{config.gcc}, normally @file{/usr/include}) in the search order.
472
473 Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
474 replacement.
475 @end defmac
476
477 @defmac NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_COMPONENT
478 The ``component'' corresponding to @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}.
479 See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
480 If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
481 @end defmac
482
483 @defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
484 Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
485 for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
486 usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
487 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
488 @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
489 and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
490 and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
491 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
492
493 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
494 Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
495 string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
496 for C++-only directories,
497 and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
498 wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
499 the array with a null element.
500
501 The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
502 if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
503 or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
504 operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
505
506 For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
507
508 @smallexample
509 #define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
510 @{ \
511 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
512 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
513 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
514 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
515 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
516 @}
517 @end smallexample
518 @end defmac
519
520 Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
521
522 @enumerate
523 @item
524 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
525
526 @item
527 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
528 is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
529 @var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
530
531 @item
532 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
533
534 @item
535 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
536 in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
537
538 @item
539 The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
540
541 @item
542 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
543
544 @item
545 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
546 compiler.
547 @end enumerate
548
549 Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
550
551 @enumerate
552 @item
553 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
554
555 @item
556 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
557 value based on the installed toolchain location.
558
559 @item
560 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
561 (or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
562
563 @item
564 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
565 in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
566
567 @item
568 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
569
570 @item
571 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
572 compiler.
573
574 @item
575 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
576 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
577
578 @item
579 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
580 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
581
582 @item
583 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
584 If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
585 the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
586
587 @item
588 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
589 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
590 @file{/lib/}.
591
592 @item
593 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
594 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
595 @file{/usr/lib/}.
596 @end enumerate
597
598 @node Run-time Target
599 @section Run-time Target Specification
600 @cindex run-time target specification
601 @cindex predefined macros
602 @cindex target specifications
603
604 @c prevent bad page break with this line
605 Here are run-time target specifications.
606
607 @defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
608 This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
609 built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
610 the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
611 @code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
612 calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
613 finished command line option processing your code can use those
614 results freely.
615
616 @code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
617 command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
618 the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
619 accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
620
621 @code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
622 object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
623 @code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
624 defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
625 with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
626 only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
627 example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
628 and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
629 @code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
630 defines only @code{_ABI64}.
631
632 You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
633 @code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
634 or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
635 assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
636 macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
637 to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
638 variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
639 @code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
640 preprocessing.
641 @end defmac
642
643 @defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
644 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
645 and is used for the target operating system instead.
646 @end defmac
647
648 @defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
649 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
650 and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
651 macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
652 it yourself.
653 @end defmac
654
655 @deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
656 This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
657 any target-specific headers.
658 @end deftypevar
659
660 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} int TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
661 This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
662 Its default setting is 0.
663 @end deftypevr
664
665 @cindex optional hardware or system features
666 @cindex features, optional, in system conventions
667
668 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts_set}, const struct cl_decoded_option *@var{decoded}, location_t @var{loc})
669 This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
670 target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
671 (@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
672 processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
673 definition does nothing but return true.
674
675 @var{decoded} specifies the option and its arguments. @var{opts} and
676 @var{opts_set} are the @code{gcc_options} structures to be used for
677 storing option state, and @var{loc} is the location at which the
678 option was passed (@code{UNKNOWN_LOCATION} except for options passed
679 via attributes).
680 @end deftypefn
681
682 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION (size_t @var{code}, const char *@var{arg}, int @var{value})
683 This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
684 target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
685 definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
686 option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
687 valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
688 default definition does nothing but return false.
689
690 In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
691 options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
692 only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
693 should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
694 @end deftypefn
695
696 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} tree TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT (tree @var{string})
697 Targets may provide a string object type that can be used within and between C, C++ and their respective Objective-C dialects. A string object might, for example, embed encoding and length information. These objects are considered opaque to the compiler and handled as references. An ideal implementation makes the composition of the string object match that of the Objective-C @code{NSString} (@code{NXString} for GNUStep), allowing efficient interworking between C-only and Objective-C code. If a target implements string objects then this hook should return a reference to such an object constructed from the normal `C' string representation provided in @var{string}. At present, the hook is used by Objective-C only, to obtain a common-format string object when the target provides one.
698 @end deftypefn
699
700 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_CLASS_REFERENCE (const char *@var{classname})
701 Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is referenced by the current TU.
702 @end deftypefn
703
704 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_CLASS_DEFINITION (const char *@var{classname})
705 Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is defined by the current TU.
706 @end deftypefn
707
708 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P (const_tree @var{stringref})
709 If a target implements string objects then this hook should return @code{true} if @var{stringref} is a valid reference to such an object.
710 @end deftypefn
711
712 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG (tree @var{format_arg}, tree @var{args_list})
713 If a target implements string objects then this hook should should provide a facility to check the function arguments in @var{args_list} against the format specifiers in @var{format_arg} where the type of @var{format_arg} is one recognized as a valid string reference type.
714 @end deftypefn
715
716 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE (void)
717 This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
718 but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
719 pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
720 attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
721 when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
722 actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
723 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
724 @end deftypefn
725
726 @defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
727 This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
728 but is only used in the C
729 language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
730 used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
731 frontends.
732 @end defmac
733
734 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} {const struct default_options *} TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
735 Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
736 various optimization levels. This variable, if defined, describes
737 options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels. These
738 options are processed once
739 just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
740 of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
741 options passed explicitly.
742
743 This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
744 options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
745 @code{optimize} attribute.
746 @end deftypevr
747
748 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
749 Set target-dependent initial values of fields in @var{opts}.
750 @end deftypefn
751
752 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS (void)
753 Set target-dependent default values for @option{--param} settings, using calls to @code{set_default_param_value}.
754 @end deftypefn
755
756 @defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
757 Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
758 during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
759 the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
760 can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
761 and @code{nomips16} attributes.
762
763 Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
764 registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
765 operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
766 in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
767 significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
768 for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
769 switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
770
771 Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
772 is 0.
773 @end defmac
774
775 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FLOAT_EXCEPTIONS_ROUNDING_SUPPORTED_P (void)
776 Returns true if the target supports IEEE 754 floating-point exceptions and rounding modes, false otherwise. This is intended to relate to the @code{float} and @code{double} types, but not necessarily @code{long double}. By default, returns true if the @code{adddf3} instruction pattern is available and false otherwise, on the assumption that hardware floating point supports exceptions and rounding modes but software floating point does not.
777 @end deftypefn
778
779 @node Per-Function Data
780 @section Defining data structures for per-function information.
781 @cindex per-function data
782 @cindex data structures
783
784 If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
785 provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
786 using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
787 nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
788 when another one comes along.
789
790 GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
791 contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
792 structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
793 @code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
794 to their own specific data.
795
796 If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
797 @code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
798 This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
799 @code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
800
801 One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
802 RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
803 RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
804 function, for level 0.
805
806 Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
807 all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
808 function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
809 stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
810 stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
811 @code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
812 the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
813 single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
814 longer supported.
815
816 @defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
817 Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
818 is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
819 The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
820 function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
821 @end defmac
822
823 @deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
824 If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
825 function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
826 target to perform any target specific initialization of the
827 @code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
828 used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
829
830 @code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
831 Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
832 GC allocation, including the structure itself.
833 @end deftypevar
834
835 @node Storage Layout
836 @section Storage Layout
837 @cindex storage layout
838
839 Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
840 alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
841 expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
842 @xref{Run-time Target}.
843
844 @defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
845 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
846 byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
847 This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
848 bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
849 be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
850 macro need not be a constant.
851
852 This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
853 bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
854 @end defmac
855
856 @defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
857 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
858 word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
859 @end defmac
860
861 @defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
862 Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
863 most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
864 memory locations and registers; see @code{REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} if the
865 order of words in memory is not the same as the order in registers. This
866 macro need not be a constant.
867 @end defmac
868
869 @defmac REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
870 On some machines, the order of words in a multiword object differs between
871 registers in memory. In such a situation, define this macro to describe
872 the order of words in a register. The macro @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} controls
873 the order of words in memory.
874 @end defmac
875
876 @defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
877 Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
878 @code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
879 containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
880 have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
881
882 You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
883 multi-word integers.
884 @end defmac
885
886 @defmac BITS_PER_WORD
887 Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
888 is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
889 @end defmac
890
891 @defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
892 Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
893 @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
894 largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
895 @end defmac
896
897 @defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
898 Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
899 register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
900 @end defmac
901
902 @defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
903 Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
904 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
905 smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
906 @end defmac
907
908 @defmac POINTER_SIZE
909 Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
910 width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
911 you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
912 a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
913 @end defmac
914
915 @defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
916 A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
917 @code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
918 greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
919 should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
920 is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
921 @code{ptr_extend} instruction.
922
923 You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
924 and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
925 @end defmac
926
927 @defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
928 A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
929 is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
930 stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
931 scalar type.
932
933 On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
934 register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
935 @var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
936 cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
937 floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
938 counterparts.
939
940 For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
941 However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
942 either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
943 the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
944 sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
945 @var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
946
947 Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
948 @end defmac
949
950 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE (const_tree @var{type}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int *@var{punsignedp}, const_tree @var{funtype}, int @var{for_return})
951 Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
952 function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
953 and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
954 change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
955 pointer} types.
956
957 @var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
958 return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
959 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
960 If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
961 which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
962 then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
963 the signedness may be different.
964
965 @var{type} can be NULL when promoting function arguments of libcalls.
966
967 The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
968 also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
969 if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
970 @end deftypefn
971
972 @defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
973 Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
974 bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
975 regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
976 size of an integer.
977 @end defmac
978
979 @defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
980 Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
981 stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
982 desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
983 if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
984 this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
985 @end defmac
986
987 @defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
988 Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
989 stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
990 is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
991 macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
992 @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
993 @end defmac
994
995 @defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
996 Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
997 from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
998 to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
999 @end defmac
1000
1001 @defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1002 Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
1003 @end defmac
1004
1005 @defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1006 Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
1007 bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
1008 just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
1009 @end defmac
1010
1011 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_ABSOLUTE_BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1012 If defined, this target hook specifies the absolute biggest alignment
1013 that a type or variable can have on this machine, otherwise,
1014 @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} is used.
1015 @end deftypevr
1016
1017 @defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
1018 Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
1019 provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
1020 @end defmac
1021
1022 @defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1023 Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1024 not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1025 @end defmac
1026
1027 @defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1028 If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1029 object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1030 nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1031 on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1032 @end defmac
1033
1034 @defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1035 Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1036 machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1037 structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1038 by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1039 @end defmac
1040
1041 @defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{computed})
1042 An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} if the
1043 alignment computed in the usual way (including applying of
1044 @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1045 alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1046 field alignment has not been set by the
1047 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1048 @end defmac
1049
1050 @defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1051 Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1052 to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1053
1054 If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1055
1056 @c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1057 @c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1058 @c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1059 @c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1060 @end defmac
1061
1062 @defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1063 Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1064 Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1065 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. If not defined,
1066 the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1067
1068 On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1069 the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1070 a 32-bit host e.g. @samp{(((uint64_t) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1071 On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1072 @samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
1073 @end defmac
1074
1075 @defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1076 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1077 the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1078 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1079 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1080
1081 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1082
1083 @findex strcpy
1084 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1085 make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1086 arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1087 constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1088 @end defmac
1089
1090 @defmac DATA_ABI_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1091 Similar to @code{DATA_ALIGNMENT}, but for the cases where the ABI mandates
1092 some alignment increase, instead of optimization only purposes. E.g.@
1093 AMD x86-64 psABI says that variables with array type larger than 15 bytes
1094 must be aligned to 16 byte boundaries.
1095
1096 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1097 @end defmac
1098
1099 @defmac CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (@var{constant}, @var{basic-align})
1100 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment given to a constant
1101 that is being placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and
1102 @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the object would ordinarily
1103 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1104 align the object.
1105
1106 The default definition just returns @var{basic-align}.
1107
1108 The typical use of this macro is to increase alignment for string
1109 constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1110 constants can be done inline.
1111 @end defmac
1112
1113 @defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1114 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1115 the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1116 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1117 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1118
1119 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1120
1121 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1122 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1123
1124 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1125 @end defmac
1126
1127 @deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT (const_tree @var{type})
1128 This hook can be used to define the alignment for a vector of type
1129 @var{type}, in order to comply with a platform ABI. The default is to
1130 require natural alignment for vector types. The alignment returned by
1131 this hook must be a power-of-two multiple of the default alignment of
1132 the vector element type.
1133 @end deftypefn
1134
1135 @defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1136 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1137 @var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1138 and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1139 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1140 align the slot.
1141
1142 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1143 @var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1144 be used.
1145
1146 This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1147 of all possible modes which the slot may have.
1148
1149 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1150 @end defmac
1151
1152 @defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1153 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1154 variable @var{decl}.
1155
1156 If this macro is not defined, then
1157 @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1158 is used.
1159
1160 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1161 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1162
1163 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1164 @end defmac
1165
1166 @defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1167 If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1168 for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1169 @var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1170
1171 If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1172 @end defmac
1173
1174 @defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1175 Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1176 empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1177
1178 If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1179 @end defmac
1180
1181 @defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1182 Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1183 Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1184
1185 If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1186 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1187 @end defmac
1188
1189 @defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1190 Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1191 if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1192 go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1193 @end defmac
1194
1195 @defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1196 Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1197 alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1198
1199 The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1200 @code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1201 structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1202 that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1203 that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1204
1205 Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1206 @code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1207 four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1208 not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1209
1210 An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1211 structure.
1212
1213 If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1214 a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1215
1216 Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1217 bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1218 support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1219 @samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1220
1221 The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1222 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1223 Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1224
1225 Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1226 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1227 @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1228
1229 If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1230 bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1231 what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1232
1233 @smallexample
1234 struct foo1
1235 @{
1236 char x;
1237 char :0;
1238 char y;
1239 @};
1240
1241 struct foo2
1242 @{
1243 char x;
1244 int :0;
1245 char y;
1246 @};
1247
1248 main ()
1249 @{
1250 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1251 sizeof (struct foo1));
1252 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1253 sizeof (struct foo2));
1254 exit (0);
1255 @}
1256 @end smallexample
1257
1258 If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1259 get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1260 @end defmac
1261
1262 @defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1263 Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1264 to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1265 @end defmac
1266
1267 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD (void)
1268 When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1269 whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1270 structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1271 the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1272 @end deftypefn
1273
1274 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD (void)
1275 This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1276 should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1277 these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1278
1279 The default is @code{false}.
1280 @end deftypefn
1281
1282 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (const_tree @var{field}, machine_mode @var{mode})
1283 Return true if a structure, union or array containing @var{field} should
1284 be accessed using @code{BLKMODE}.
1285
1286 If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1287 mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1288 case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1289 retain the field's mode.
1290
1291 Normally, this is not needed.
1292 @end deftypefn
1293
1294 @defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1295 Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1296 by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1297 way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1298 @var{specified}.
1299
1300 The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1301 the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1302 @end defmac
1303
1304 @defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1305 An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1306 machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1307 this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1308 appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1309 (DImode)} is assumed.
1310 @end defmac
1311
1312 @defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1313 If defined, an expression of type @code{machine_mode} that
1314 specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1315 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1316 @var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1317 @code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1318 having its mode specified.
1319
1320 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1321 would most commonly define this macro if the
1322 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
1323 64-bit mode.
1324 @end defmac
1325
1326 @defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1327 If defined, an expression of type @code{machine_mode} that
1328 specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1329 @code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1330
1331 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1332 You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1333 pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1334 @end defmac
1335
1336 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE (void)
1337 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1338 of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1339 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1340 targets.
1341 @end deftypefn
1342
1343 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE (void)
1344 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1345 of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1346 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1347 targets.
1348 @end deftypefn
1349
1350 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE (void)
1351 Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1352 The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1353 @end deftypefn
1354
1355 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P (const_tree @var{record_type})
1356 This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1357 @var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1358 Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1359 unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1360 different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1361 alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1362 bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1363 the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1364 (iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1365 another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
1366 other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1367
1368 When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1369 of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1370 bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1371 and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1372 chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1373 size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1374 alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1375
1376 If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1377 the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1378 used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1379 precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1380 may affect its placement.
1381 @end deftypefn
1382
1383 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1384 Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
1385 @end deftypefn
1386
1387 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1388 Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1389 @end deftypefn
1390
1391 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK (void)
1392 This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1393 to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1394 For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1395 for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1396 registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1397 usage.
1398 @end deftypefn
1399
1400 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS (void)
1401 This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1402 that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1403 @end deftypefn
1404
1405 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
1406 If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1407 uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1408 to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1409 mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1410 the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1411 not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1412 for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1413 return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1414 string constant.
1415
1416 Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1417 qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1418 fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1419 is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1420 length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1421 ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1422 @var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1423 @var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1424 code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1425 @code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1426 codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1427 spaces in your string.
1428
1429 This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1430 name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1431 can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1432 before mangling.
1433
1434 The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1435 appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1436 types.
1437 @end deftypefn
1438
1439 @node Type Layout
1440 @section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1441
1442 These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1443 basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1444 the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1445 languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1446
1447 @defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1448 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1449 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1450 @end defmac
1451
1452 @defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1453 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1454 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1455 (If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1456 unit.)
1457 @end defmac
1458
1459 @defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1460 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1461 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1462 @end defmac
1463
1464 @defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1465 On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1466 @code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1467 that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1468 the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1469 value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1470 @end defmac
1471
1472 @defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1473 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1474 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1475 words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1476 macro must be at least 64.
1477 @end defmac
1478
1479 @defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1480 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1481 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1482 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1483 @end defmac
1484
1485 @defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1486 A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1487 C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1488 this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1489 @end defmac
1490
1491 @defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1492 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1493 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1494 @end defmac
1495
1496 @defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1497 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1498 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1499 words.
1500 @end defmac
1501
1502 @defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1503 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1504 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1505 words.
1506 @end defmac
1507
1508 @defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1509 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1510 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1511 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1512 @end defmac
1513
1514 @defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1515 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1516 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1517 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1518 @end defmac
1519
1520 @defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1521 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1522 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1523 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1524 @end defmac
1525
1526 @defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1527 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1528 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1529 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1530 @end defmac
1531
1532 @defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1533 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1534 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1535 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1536 @end defmac
1537
1538 @defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1539 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1540 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1541 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1542 @end defmac
1543
1544 @defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1545 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1546 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1547 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1548 @end defmac
1549
1550 @defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1551 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1552 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1553 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1554 @end defmac
1555
1556 @defmac LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX
1557 This macro corresponds to the @code{TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX} target
1558 hook and should be defined if that hook is overriden to be true. It
1559 causes function names in libgcc to be changed to use a @code{__gnu_}
1560 prefix for their name rather than the default @code{__}. A port which
1561 uses this macro should also arrange to use @file{t-gnu-prefix} in
1562 the libgcc @file{config.host}.
1563 @end defmac
1564
1565 @defmac TARGET_FLT_EVAL_METHOD
1566 A C expression for the value for @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} in @file{float.h},
1567 assuming, if applicable, that the floating-point control word is in its
1568 default state. If you do not define this macro the value of
1569 @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} will be zero.
1570 @end defmac
1571
1572 @defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1573 A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1574 supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1575 value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1576 If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1577 is the default.
1578 @end defmac
1579
1580 @defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1581 An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1582 @code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1583 always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1584 and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1585 @end defmac
1586
1587 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS (void)
1588 This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1589 @code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1590 of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
1591 @code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1592
1593 The default is to return false.
1594 @end deftypefn
1595
1596 @defmac SIZE_TYPE
1597 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1598 for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1599 contents of the string.
1600
1601 The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1602 spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1603 appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1604 of the data type names defined in the function
1605 @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins} in the file @file{c-family/c-common.c}.
1606 You may not omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the
1607 compiler to crash on startup.
1608
1609 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1610 int"}.
1611 @end defmac
1612
1613 @defmac SIZETYPE
1614 GCC defines internal types (@code{sizetype}, @code{ssizetype},
1615 @code{bitsizetype} and @code{sbitsizetype}) for expressions
1616 dealing with size. This macro is a C expression for a string describing
1617 the name of the data type from which the precision of @code{sizetype}
1618 is extracted.
1619
1620 The string has the same restrictions as @code{SIZE_TYPE} string.
1621
1622 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{SIZE_TYPE}.
1623 @end defmac
1624
1625 @defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1626 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1627 for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1628 @code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1629 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1630
1631 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1632 @end defmac
1633
1634 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE
1635 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1636 for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1637 the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1638 information.
1639
1640 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1641 @end defmac
1642
1643 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1644 A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1645 characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1646 @code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1647 @end defmac
1648
1649 @defmac WINT_TYPE
1650 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1651 use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1652 @code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1653 contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1654 information.
1655
1656 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1657 @end defmac
1658
1659 @defmac INTMAX_TYPE
1660 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1661 can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1662 The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1663 string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1664
1665 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1666 @code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1667 much precision as @code{long long int}.
1668 @end defmac
1669
1670 @defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1671 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1672 can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1673 type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1674 of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1675
1676 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1677 @code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1678 unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1679 int}.
1680 @end defmac
1681
1682 @defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1683 @defmacx INT8_TYPE
1684 @defmacx INT16_TYPE
1685 @defmacx INT32_TYPE
1686 @defmacx INT64_TYPE
1687 @defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1688 @defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1689 @defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1690 @defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1691 @defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1692 @defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1693 @defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1694 @defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1695 @defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1696 @defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1697 @defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1698 @defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1699 @defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1700 @defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1701 @defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1702 @defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1703 @defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1704 @defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1705 @defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1706 @defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1707 @defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1708 @defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1709 C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1710 @code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1711 @code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1712 @code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1713 @code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1714 @code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1715 @code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1716 @code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1717 @code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1718 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1719
1720 If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1721 type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1722 @code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1723 to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1724 these macros are null pointers.
1725 @end defmac
1726
1727 @defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1728 The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1729 that looks like:
1730
1731 @smallexample
1732 struct @{
1733 union @{
1734 void (*fn)();
1735 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1736 @};
1737 ptrdiff_t delta;
1738 @};
1739 @end smallexample
1740
1741 @noindent
1742 The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1743 will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1744 Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1745 always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1746 distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1747 platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1748 that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1749 the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1750
1751 GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1752 this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1753 However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1754 set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1755 bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1756 address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1757 architecture, you should define this macro to
1758 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1759
1760 In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1761 in which function addresses are always even, according to
1762 @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1763 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1764 @end defmac
1765
1766 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1767 Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
1768 macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1769 instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1770 function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
1771 data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1772 pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1773
1774 If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1775 of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1776 @end defmac
1777
1778 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1779 By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1780 is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1781 the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1782 when special alignment is necessary. */
1783 @end defmac
1784
1785 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1786 There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1787 zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1788 specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1789 of words in each data entry.
1790 @end defmac
1791
1792 @node Registers
1793 @section Register Usage
1794 @cindex register usage
1795
1796 This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1797 has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1798
1799 The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1800 done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1801 on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1802 For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1803 For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1804
1805 @menu
1806 * Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1807 * Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1808 * Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1809 * Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1810 * Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1811 @end menu
1812
1813 @node Register Basics
1814 @subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1815
1816 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1817 Registers have various characteristics.
1818
1819 @defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1820 Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1821 numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1822 pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1823 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1824 @end defmac
1825
1826 @defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1827 @cindex fixed register
1828 An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1829 all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1830 general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1831 pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1832 register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1833 machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1834 and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1835
1836 This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1837 commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1838 register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1839
1840 The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1841 the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1842 by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1843 the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1844 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1845 @end defmac
1846
1847 @defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1848 @cindex call-used register
1849 @cindex call-clobbered register
1850 @cindex call-saved register
1851 Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1852 clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1853 registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1854 available for general allocation of values that must live across
1855 function calls.
1856
1857 If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1858 automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1859 exit, if the register is used within the function.
1860 @end defmac
1861
1862 @defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1863 @cindex call-used register
1864 @cindex call-clobbered register
1865 @cindex call-saved register
1866 Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1867 that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1868 (@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1869 This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
1870 of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1871 @end defmac
1872
1873 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
1874 @cindex call-used register
1875 @cindex call-clobbered register
1876 @cindex call-saved register
1877 A C expression that is nonzero if it is not permissible to store a
1878 value of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} across a
1879 call without some part of it being clobbered. For most machines this
1880 macro need not be defined. It is only required for machines that do not
1881 preserve the entire contents of a register across a call.
1882 @end defmac
1883
1884 @findex fixed_regs
1885 @findex call_used_regs
1886 @findex global_regs
1887 @findex reg_names
1888 @findex reg_class_contents
1889 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE (void)
1890 This hook may conditionally modify five variables
1891 @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1892 @code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1893 any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1894 of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as Boolean vectors).
1895 @code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1896 @code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1897 called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1898 @code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1899 from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1900 @code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1901 @code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1902 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1903 command options have been applied.
1904
1905 @cindex disabling certain registers
1906 @cindex controlling register usage
1907 If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1908 flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1909 @code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1910 registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also make
1911 @code{define_register_constraint}s return @code{NO_REGS} for constraints
1912 that shouldn't be used.
1913
1914 (However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1915 of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1916 controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1917 these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
1918 @end deftypefn
1919
1920 @defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1921 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1922 expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1923 corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1924 function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1925 outbound register.
1926 @end defmac
1927
1928 @defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1929 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1930 expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1931 corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1932 function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1933 register.
1934 @end defmac
1935
1936 @defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1937 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1938 expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1939 register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1940 need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1941 gotos.
1942 @end defmac
1943
1944 @defmac PC_REGNUM
1945 If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
1946 register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
1947 @end defmac
1948
1949 @node Allocation Order
1950 @subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
1951 @cindex order of register allocation
1952 @cindex register allocation order
1953
1954 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1955 Registers are allocated in order.
1956
1957 @defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1958 If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
1959 numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
1960 to use them (from most preferred to least).
1961
1962 If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
1963 (all else being equal).
1964
1965 One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
1966 registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
1967 instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
1968 machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
1969 the highest numbered allocable register first.
1970 @end defmac
1971
1972 @defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1973 A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
1974 hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
1975
1976 Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
1977 Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
1978 register; and so on.
1979
1980 The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
1981 @code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
1982
1983 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
1984 @end defmac
1985
1986 @defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
1987 Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
1988 prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
1989 using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
1990 allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
1991 call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, then define this
1992 macro as a C expression to nonzero. Default is 0.
1993 @end defmac
1994
1995 @defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
1996 In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
1997 Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
1998 If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
1999 based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
2000 be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2001 value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
2002 to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2003
2004 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2005 @end defmac
2006
2007 @node Values in Registers
2008 @subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2009
2010 This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2011 (specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2012 consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2013
2014 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2015 A C expression for the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2016 at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2017 @var{mode}. This macro must never return zero, even if a register
2018 cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK
2019 and/or CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS instead.
2020
2021 On a machine where all registers are exactly one word, a suitable
2022 definition of this macro is
2023
2024 @smallexample
2025 #define HARD_REGNO_NREGS(REGNO, MODE) \
2026 ((GET_MODE_SIZE (MODE) + UNITS_PER_WORD - 1) \
2027 / UNITS_PER_WORD)
2028 @end smallexample
2029 @end defmac
2030
2031 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2032 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2033 in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2034 in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2035 multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2036 this mode by the number of registers returned by
2037 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2038
2039 For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2040 registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2041 nonzero.
2042
2043 This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
2044 @code{subreg_get_info}
2045 would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2046 represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2047 @code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2048 registers and so not be representable.
2049 @end defmac
2050
2051 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2052 For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2053 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2054 returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2055 including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2056 @end defmac
2057
2058 @defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2059 Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2060 of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2061 should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2062 used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2063 happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2064 floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2065 @end defmac
2066
2067 @defmac HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2068 A C expression that is nonzero if it is permissible to store a value
2069 of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2070 registers starting with that one). For a machine where all registers
2071 are equivalent, a suitable definition is
2072
2073 @smallexample
2074 #define HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK(REGNO, MODE) 1
2075 @end smallexample
2076
2077 You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2078 because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2079
2080 @cindex register pairs
2081 On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2082 register pairs. You can implement that by defining this macro to reject
2083 odd register numbers for such modes.
2084
2085 The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2086 @samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2087 register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2088 value into the register and back out not alter it.
2089
2090 Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2091 all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2092 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} to distinguish between these modes, provided
2093 you define patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This
2094 is useful because of the interaction between @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2095 and @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer modes
2096 to be tieable.
2097
2098 Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2099 Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2100 in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2101 can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2102 mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2103 registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2104
2105 On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2106 modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2107 registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2108 non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2109 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2110 floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2111 normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2112 unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2113 register, so you can define this macro to say so.
2114
2115 The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2116 they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2117 instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2118 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2119 constraints for those instructions.
2120
2121 On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2122 so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2123 register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2124 floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2125 be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2126 @end defmac
2127
2128 @defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2129 A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2130 @var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2131
2132 One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2133 another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2134 handler.
2135
2136 The default is always nonzero.
2137 @end defmac
2138
2139 @defmac MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})
2140 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode
2141 @var{mode1} is accessible in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2142
2143 If @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2144 @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always the same for
2145 any @var{r}, then @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2146 should be nonzero. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2147 this macro to return zero unless some other mechanism ensures the
2148 accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2149
2150 You should define this macro to return nonzero in as many cases as
2151 possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2152 allocation.
2153 @end defmac
2154
2155 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK (unsigned int @var{regno})
2156 This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2157 @var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2158
2159 One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2160 is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2161
2162 The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2163 @end deftypefn
2164
2165 @defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2166 Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2167 registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2168 @code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2169 @end defmac
2170
2171 @node Leaf Functions
2172 @subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2173
2174 @cindex leaf functions
2175 @cindex functions, leaf
2176 On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2177 more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2178 means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2179 are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2180 normally arrive.
2181
2182 The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2183 other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2184 registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2185 function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2186 handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2187 functions''.
2188
2189 GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2190 suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2191 registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2192 accomplish this.
2193
2194 @defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2195 Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2196 contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2197 function treatment.
2198
2199 If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2200 registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2201 GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
2202 used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2203 in this vector.
2204
2205 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2206 the treatment of leaf functions.
2207 @end defmac
2208
2209 @defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2210 A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2211 should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2212
2213 If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2214 function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2215 will cause the compiler to abort.
2216
2217 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2218 treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2219 this.
2220 @end defmac
2221
2222 @findex current_function_is_leaf
2223 @findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2224 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2225 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2226 specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2227 which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2228 set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2229 compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2230 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2231 functions which only use leaf registers.
2232 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2233 that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2234 @code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2235 @c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2236 @c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2237
2238 @node Stack Registers
2239 @subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2240
2241 There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2242 ``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2243 pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2244 stack.
2245
2246 Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2247 they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2248 support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2249 point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2250 stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2251 @file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2252 with it, as well as defining these macros.
2253
2254 @defmac STACK_REGS
2255 Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2256 @end defmac
2257
2258 @defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2259 This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2260 the machine has any stack-like registers.
2261 @end defmac
2262
2263 @defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2264 The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2265 of the stack.
2266 @end defmac
2267
2268 @defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2269 The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2270 the stack.
2271 @end defmac
2272
2273 @node Register Classes
2274 @section Register Classes
2275 @cindex register class definitions
2276 @cindex class definitions, register
2277
2278 On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2279 For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2280 certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2281 restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2282
2283 You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2284 which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2285 that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2286
2287 @findex ALL_REGS
2288 @findex NO_REGS
2289 In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2290 class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2291 class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2292 union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2293
2294 @findex GENERAL_REGS
2295 One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2296 terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2297 @samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2298 the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2299 to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2300
2301 Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2302 then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2303
2304 The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2305 constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2306 You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2307 them in operand constraints.
2308
2309 You must define the narrowest register classes for allocatable
2310 registers, so that each class either has no subclasses, or that for
2311 some mode, the move cost between registers within the class is
2312 cheaper than moving a register in the class to or from memory
2313 (@pxref{Costs}).
2314
2315 You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2316 instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2317 either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2318 certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2319 which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code,
2320 or even internal compiler errors when reload cannot find a register in the
2321 class computed via @code{reg_class_subunion}.
2322
2323 You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2324 classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2325 contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2326 in their union.
2327
2328 When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2329 certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2330 Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2331 a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2332 specify this requirement is with @code{HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2333
2334 Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2335 instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2336 each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2337 mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2338 single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2339 this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2340 instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2341 single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2342 @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2343
2344 @deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2345 An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2346 as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2347 must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2348 @code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2349 tells how many classes there are.
2350
2351 Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2352 the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2353 in many of the tables described below.
2354 @end deftp
2355
2356 @defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2357 The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2358
2359 @smallexample
2360 #define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2361 @end smallexample
2362 @end defmac
2363
2364 @defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2365 An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2366 constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2367 @end defmac
2368
2369 @defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2370 An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2371 which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2372 @var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2373 register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2374
2375 When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2376 Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2377 several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2378 for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2379 In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2380 registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2381 so on.
2382 @end defmac
2383
2384 @defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2385 A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2386 @var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2387 which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2388 register.
2389 @end defmac
2390
2391 @defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2392 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2393 base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2394 which is the register value plus a displacement.
2395 @end defmac
2396
2397 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2398 This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2399 the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2400 @var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2401 @code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2402 @end defmac
2403
2404 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2405 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2406 base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2407 register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2408 addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2409 @end defmac
2410
2411 @defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2412 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2413 base register for a memory reference in mode @var{mode} to address
2414 space @var{address_space} must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code}
2415 define the context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is
2416 the code of the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level
2417 of an address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2418 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2419 index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2420 @end defmac
2421
2422 @defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2423 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2424 index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2425 address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2426 added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2427 @end defmac
2428
2429 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2430 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2431 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
2432 @end defmac
2433
2434 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2435 A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2436 that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2437 @var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2438 reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2439 you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2440 @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2441 addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2442 @code{address_operand}.
2443 @end defmac
2444
2445 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2446 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2447 use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2448 memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2449 pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2450 define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2451 than other base register uses.
2452
2453 Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2454 @code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2455 @end defmac
2456
2457 @defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2458 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2459 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses, accessing
2460 memory in mode @var{mode} in address space @var{address_space}.
2461 This is similar to @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
2462 that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2463 appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2464 immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2465 address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2466 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2467 corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2468 @code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2469 that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
2470 @end defmac
2471
2472 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2473 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2474 suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2475 either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2476 allocated such a hard register.
2477
2478 The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2479 the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2480 two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2481 labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2482 labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2483 may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2484 looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2485 only if neither labeling works.
2486 @end defmac
2487
2488 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RENAME_CLASS (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2489 A target hook that places additional preference on the register class to use when it is necessary to rename a register in class @var{rclass} to another class, or perhaps @var{NO_REGS}, if no preferred register class is found or hook @code{preferred_rename_class} is not implemented. Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For example, on ARM, thumb-2 instructions using @code{LO_REGS} may be smaller than instructions using @code{GENERIC_REGS}. By returning @code{LO_REGS} from @code{preferred_rename_class}, code size can be reduced.
2490 @end deftypefn
2491
2492 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2493 A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2494 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2495 @var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2496 another, smaller class.
2497
2498 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2499
2500 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2501 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2502 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2503 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2504 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2505
2506 One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2507 @var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2508 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2509 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2510 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2511 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2512 register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2513 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2514 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2515 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2516 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2517
2518 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2519 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2520 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2521 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2522 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2523 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2524 @end deftypefn
2525
2526 @defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2527 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2528 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2529 @var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2530 another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2531 safe:
2532
2533 @smallexample
2534 #define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2535 @end smallexample
2536
2537 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2538 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2539 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2540 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2541 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2542
2543 One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2544 @var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2545 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2546 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2547 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2548 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2549 register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2550 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2551 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2552 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2553 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2554
2555 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2556 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2557 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2558 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2559 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2560 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2561 @end defmac
2562
2563 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2564 Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2565 input reloads.
2566
2567 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2568 argument.
2569
2570 You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2571 reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2572 @end deftypefn
2573
2574 @defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2575 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2576 to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2577 @var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2578 ordinarily be used.
2579
2580 Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2581 there are certain modes that simply can't go in certain reload classes.
2582
2583 The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2584 smaller class.
2585
2586 Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2587 require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2588 @end defmac
2589
2590 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD (bool @var{in_p}, rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{reload_class}, machine_mode @var{reload_mode}, secondary_reload_info *@var{sri})
2591 Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2592 from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2593 @samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2594 from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2595 term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2596 directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2597 register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2598 destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2599 source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2600 reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2601 and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2602 intermediate register still holds the required value.
2603
2604 Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2605 allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2606 register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2607 address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2608 when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
2609 as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
2610 that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2611 describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2612 these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2613 of the scratch register(s).
2614
2615 In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2616
2617 For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
2618 and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
2619 @var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
2620 hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
2621 needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2622
2623 If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2624 an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2625 return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2626 If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2627 If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2628 that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2629
2630 If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2631 perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2632 closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2633 required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2634 copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2635
2636 You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2637 in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2638 and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2639 for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2640 single-register-class
2641 @c [later: or memory]
2642 output constraint.
2643
2644 When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2645 hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2646 register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2647 have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2648
2649 @c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2650 @c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2651 @c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2652 @c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2653 @c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2654 @c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2655 @c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2656 @c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2657
2658
2659 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2660 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2661 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2662 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2663
2664 Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2665 currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2666 to use @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2667
2668 @code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2669 copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2670 (a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2671 Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2672 of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2673 forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2674 @end deftypefn
2675
2676 @defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2677 @defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2678 @defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2679 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2680 @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2681
2682 These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2683 target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2684 reload phase that it may
2685 need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2686 register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2687 register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2688 you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2689 largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2690 intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2691
2692 If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2693 intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2694 was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2695 class required. If the
2696 requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2697 @code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2698 macros identically.
2699
2700 The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2701 Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2702 can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2703 @var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2704 macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2705
2706 If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2707 intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2708 @samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2709 (@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
2710 implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2711 @samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2712 register.
2713
2714 These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2715 register that
2716 contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2717 class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2718 value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2719 register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2720 Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2721
2722 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2723 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2724 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2725 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2726
2727 These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2728 registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2729 registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2730 would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2731 the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2732 intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2733 general registers.
2734 @end defmac
2735
2736 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (@var{class1}, @var{class2}, @var{m})
2737 Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2738 to some other registers without using memory. Define this macro on
2739 those machines to be a C expression that is nonzero if objects of mode
2740 @var{m} in registers of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of
2741 class @var{class2} by storing a register of @var{class1} into memory
2742 and loading that memory location into a register of @var{class2}.
2743
2744 Do not define this macro if its value would always be zero.
2745 @end defmac
2746
2747 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2748 Normally when @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2749 allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2750 If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2751 defined by this macro.
2752
2753 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2754 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2755 @end defmac
2756
2757 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (@var{mode})
2758 When the compiler needs a secondary memory location to copy between two
2759 registers of mode @var{mode}, it normally allocates sufficient memory to
2760 hold a quantity of @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits and performs the store and
2761 load operations in a mode that many bits wide and whose class is the
2762 same as that of @var{mode}.
2763
2764 This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures that all
2765 bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the registers
2766 in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for floating-point
2767 registers.
2768
2769 However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2770 the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2771 differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2772 widening will not work correctly and you must define this macro to
2773 suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.h} for
2774 details.
2775
2776 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2777 @code{SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} or if widening @var{mode} to a mode that
2778 is @code{BITS_PER_WORD} bits wide is correct for your machine.
2779 @end defmac
2780
2781 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2782 A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2783 to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2784 registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2785
2786 The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2787 has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
2788 default should be used. For generally register-starved machines, such as
2789 i386, or machines with right register constraints, such as SH, this hook
2790 can be used to avoid excessive spilling.
2791
2792 This hook is also used by some of the global intra-procedural code
2793 transformations to throtle code motion, to avoid increasing register
2794 pressure.
2795 @end deftypefn
2796
2797 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (reg_class_t @var{rclass}, machine_mode @var{mode})
2798 A target hook returns the maximum number of consecutive registers
2799 of class @var{rclass} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2800
2801 This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2802 the value returned by @code{TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{rclass},
2803 @var{mode})} target hook should be the maximum value of
2804 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})} for all @var{regno}
2805 values in the class @var{rclass}.
2806
2807 This target hook helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2808 in the reload pass.
2809
2810 The default version of this target hook returns the size of @var{mode}
2811 in words.
2812 @end deftypefn
2813
2814 @defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2815 A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2816 of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2817
2818 This is closely related to the macro @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2819 the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2820 should be the maximum value of @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2821 @var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2822
2823 This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2824 in the reload pass.
2825 @end defmac
2826
2827 @defmac CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (@var{from}, @var{to}, @var{class})
2828 If defined, a C expression that returns nonzero for a @var{class} for which
2829 a change from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to} is invalid.
2830
2831 For example, loading 32-bit integer or floating-point objects into
2832 floating-point registers on Alpha extends them to 64 bits.
2833 Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a 32-bit object
2834 does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case for a normal
2835 register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS}
2836 as below:
2837
2838 @smallexample
2839 #define CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS(FROM, TO, CLASS) \
2840 (GET_MODE_SIZE (FROM) != GET_MODE_SIZE (TO) \
2841 ? reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, (CLASS)) : 0)
2842 @end smallexample
2843
2844 Even if storing from a register in mode @var{to} would be valid,
2845 if both @var{from} and @code{raw_reg_mode} for @var{class} are wider
2846 than @code{word_mode}, then we must prevent @var{to} narrowing the
2847 mode. This happens when the middle-end assumes that it can load
2848 or store pieces of an @var{N}-word pseudo, and that the pseudo will
2849 eventually be allocated to @var{N} @code{word_mode} hard registers.
2850 Failure to prevent this kind of mode change will result in the
2851 entire @code{raw_reg_mode} being modified instead of the partial
2852 value that the middle-end intended.
2853
2854 @end defmac
2855
2856 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_IRA_CHANGE_PSEUDO_ALLOCNO_CLASS (int, @var{reg_class_t})
2857 A target hook which can change allocno class for given pseudo from
2858 allocno class calculated by IRA.
2859
2860 The default version of this target hook always returns given class.
2861 @end deftypefn
2862
2863 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LRA_P (void)
2864 A target hook which returns true if we use LRA instead of reload pass. It means that LRA was ported to the target. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2865 @end deftypefn
2866
2867 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_PRIORITY (int)
2868 A target hook which returns the register priority number to which the register @var{hard_regno} belongs to. The bigger the number, the more preferable the hard register usage (when all other conditions are the same). This hook can be used to prefer some hard register over others in LRA. For example, some x86-64 register usage needs additional prefix which makes instructions longer. The hook can return lower priority number for such registers make them less favorable and as result making the generated code smaller. The default version of this target hook returns always zero.
2869 @end deftypefn
2870
2871 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REGISTER_USAGE_LEVELING_P (void)
2872 A target hook which returns true if we need register usage leveling. That means if a few hard registers are equally good for the assignment, we choose the least used hard register. The register usage leveling may be profitable for some targets. Don't use the usage leveling for targets with conditional execution or targets with big register files as it hurts if-conversion and cross-jumping optimizations. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2873 @end deftypefn
2874
2875 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DIFFERENT_ADDR_DISPLACEMENT_P (void)
2876 A target hook which returns true if an address with the same structure can have different maximal legitimate displacement. For example, the displacement can depend on memory mode or on operand combinations in the insn. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2877 @end deftypefn
2878
2879 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_SUBSTITUTE_MEM_EQUIV_P (rtx @var{subst})
2880 A target hook which returns @code{true} if @var{subst} can't
2881 substitute safely pseudos with equivalent memory values during
2882 register allocation.
2883 The default version of this target hook returns @code{false}.
2884 On most machines, this default should be used. For generally
2885 machines with non orthogonal register usage for addressing, such
2886 as SH, this hook can be used to avoid excessive spilling.
2887 @end deftypefn
2888
2889 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS_DISPLACEMENT (rtx *@var{disp}, rtx *@var{offset}, machine_mode @var{mode})
2890 A target hook which returns @code{true} if *@var{disp} is
2891 legitimezed to valid address displacement with subtracting *@var{offset}
2892 at memory mode @var{mode}.
2893 The default version of this target hook returns @code{false}.
2894 This hook will benefit machines with limited base plus displacement
2895 addressing.
2896 @end deftypefn
2897
2898 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SPILL_CLASS (reg_class_t, @var{machine_mode})
2899 This hook defines a class of registers which could be used for spilling pseudos of the given mode and class, or @code{NO_REGS} if only memory should be used. Not defining this hook is equivalent to returning @code{NO_REGS} for all inputs.
2900 @end deftypefn
2901
2902 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_CSTORE_MODE (enum insn_code @var{icode})
2903 This hook defines the machine mode to use for the boolean result of conditional store patterns. The ICODE argument is the instruction code for the cstore being performed. Not definiting this hook is the same as accepting the mode encoded into operand 0 of the cstore expander patterns.
2904 @end deftypefn
2905
2906 @node Stack and Calling
2907 @section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
2908 @cindex calling conventions
2909
2910 @c prevent bad page break with this line
2911 This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
2912
2913 @menu
2914 * Frame Layout::
2915 * Exception Handling::
2916 * Stack Checking::
2917 * Frame Registers::
2918 * Elimination::
2919 * Stack Arguments::
2920 * Register Arguments::
2921 * Scalar Return::
2922 * Aggregate Return::
2923 * Caller Saves::
2924 * Function Entry::
2925 * Profiling::
2926 * Tail Calls::
2927 * Stack Smashing Protection::
2928 * Miscellaneous Register Hooks::
2929 @end menu
2930
2931 @node Frame Layout
2932 @subsection Basic Stack Layout
2933 @cindex stack frame layout
2934 @cindex frame layout
2935
2936 @c prevent bad page break with this line
2937 Here is the basic stack layout.
2938
2939 @defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2940 Define this macro to be true if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
2941 pointer to a smaller address, and false otherwise.
2942 @end defmac
2943
2944 @defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
2945 This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
2946 on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
2947 @code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
2948
2949 The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
2950 and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
2951 the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
2952 to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
2953 space for the next item on the stack.
2954
2955 The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
2956 true, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
2957 which is often wrong.
2958 @end defmac
2959
2960 @defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
2961 Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
2962 are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
2963 @end defmac
2964
2965 @defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
2966 Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
2967 addresses on the stack.
2968 @end defmac
2969
2970 @defmac STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET
2971 Offset from the frame pointer to the first local variable slot to be allocated.
2972
2973 If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, find the next slot's offset by
2974 subtracting the first slot's length from @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2975 Otherwise, it is found by adding the length of the first slot to the
2976 value @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET}.
2977 @c i'm not sure if the above is still correct.. had to change it to get
2978 @c rid of an overfull. --mew 2feb93
2979 @end defmac
2980
2981 @defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
2982 Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
2983 The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
2984
2985 On ports where @code{STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
2986 is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
2987 alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
2988 stack alignment and do it in the backend.
2989 @end defmac
2990
2991 @defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
2992 Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
2993 outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
2994 zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
2995
2996 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
2997 the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
2998 @end defmac
2999
3000 @defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3001 Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3002 address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3003 function.
3004
3005 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3006 the first argument's address.
3007 @end defmac
3008
3009 @defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3010 Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3011 on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3012
3013 The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3014 length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
3015 machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
3016 @end defmac
3017
3018 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3019 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
3020 stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
3021 @code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3022 default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
3023 elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
3024 @code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
3025 @end defmac
3026
3027 @defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
3028 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3029 frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3030 @var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3031 itself.
3032
3033 If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3034 of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3035 address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
3036 @end defmac
3037
3038 @defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3039 A C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3040 setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
3041 on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
3042 before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3043 define this macro. The default is to do nothing.
3044 @end defmac
3045
3046 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE (void)
3047 This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
3048 the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3049 The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
3050 machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
3051 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
3052 @end deftypefn
3053
3054 @defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3055 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3056 address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3057 of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3058 You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3059 as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3060 @end defmac
3061
3062 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
3063 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
3064 address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3065 the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3066 frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
3067 @code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is nonzero.
3068
3069 The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
3070 @var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
3071 determine the return address of other frames.
3072 @end defmac
3073
3074 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
3075 Define this macro to nonzero value if the return address of a particular
3076 stack frame is accessed from the frame pointer of the previous stack
3077 frame. The zero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3078 @end defmac
3079
3080 @defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
3081 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3082 incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3083 prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3084 value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3085 the stack.
3086
3087 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3088 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3089
3090 If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
3091 @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
3092 @end defmac
3093
3094 @defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
3095 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
3096 number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3097 must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3098 be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3099
3100 This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3101 general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3102 frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3103 over time.
3104 @end defmac
3105
3106 @defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3107 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3108 number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3109 only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3110 someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3111 terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3112 @end defmac
3113
3114 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC (const char *@var{label}, rtx @var{pattern}, int @var{index})
3115 This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3116 contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3117 info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3118 @smallexample
3119 (set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
3120 @end smallexample
3121 and
3122 @smallexample
3123 (set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
3124 @end smallexample
3125 to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3126 the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3127 the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3128 @end deftypefn
3129
3130 @defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3131 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3132 from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3133 frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3134 the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3135 previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3136
3137 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3138 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3139 @end defmac
3140
3141 @defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3142 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3143 from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
3144 final value should coincide with that calculated by
3145 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3146 during virtual register instantiation.
3147
3148 The default value for this macro is
3149 @code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
3150 which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
3151 immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3152 some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3153 and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
3154
3155 You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
3156 want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3157 DWARF 2.
3158 @end defmac
3159
3160 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3161 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3162 in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
3163 The final value should coincide with that calculated by
3164 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3165
3166 Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
3167 via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
3168 variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
3169 defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
3170 based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3171 of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3172 should be defined.
3173 @end defmac
3174
3175 @defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3176 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3177 in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3178 in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3179 may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3180 @end defmac
3181
3182 @node Exception Handling
3183 @subsection Exception Handling Support
3184 @cindex exception handling
3185
3186 @defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
3187 A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3188 data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3189 @var{N} registers are usable.
3190
3191 The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3192 handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3193 should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3194 but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
3195 2 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3196
3197 You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3198 handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
3199 @end defmac
3200
3201 @defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
3202 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3203 to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3204 This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3205 It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3206
3207 Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
3208 untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3209
3210 Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
3211 by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3212 this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3213 stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3214 this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
3215 that provided by DWARF 2.
3216 @end defmac
3217
3218 @defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3219 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3220 to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3221 return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3222
3223 Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3224 return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3225 address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3226 the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3227 frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3228 been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3229 target call frame.
3230
3231 Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3232 address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3233 the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3234
3235 If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3236 define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3237 @end defmac
3238
3239 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3240 If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3241 to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3242 exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3243 using it to return to the exception handler.
3244 @end defmac
3245
3246 @defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3247 This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3248 handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3249 that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3250 and so may be read-only.
3251
3252 @var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3253 @var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3254 The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3255 as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3256
3257 If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3258 represented directly.
3259 @end defmac
3260
3261 @defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3262 This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3263 to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3264 Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3265 be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3266
3267 This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3268 handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3269 of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3270 to be emitted.
3271 @end defmac
3272
3273 @defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3274 This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
3275 code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3276 available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3277 through signal frames.
3278
3279 This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3280 @file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3281 @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3282 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3283 for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3284 the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3285 save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3286 evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3287 the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3288
3289 For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3290 @code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3291 @end defmac
3292
3293 @defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3294 This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3295 call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3296 usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3297
3298 This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in libgcc's
3299 @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3300 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3301 for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3302 @code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3303 be updated in @var{fs}.
3304 @end defmac
3305
3306 @defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3307 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3308 info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3309 linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3310 @end defmac
3311
3312 @node Stack Checking
3313 @subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3314
3315 GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3316 stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3317 three ways:
3318
3319 @enumerate
3320 @item
3321 If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3322 will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3323 at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3324 other special processing.
3325
3326 @item
3327 If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3328 @code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3329 that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3330 static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3331 in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3332 stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3333 approach below.
3334
3335 @item
3336 If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3337 ``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3338 @end enumerate
3339
3340 If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3341 GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3342 @option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3343 dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
3344
3345 @defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3346 A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3347 machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
3348 is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
3349 checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3350 value of this macro is zero.
3351 @end defmac
3352
3353 @defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3354 A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3355 in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3356 like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3357 approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
3358 @end defmac
3359
3360 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3361 An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3362 instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3363 define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3364 the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3365 of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
3366 @end defmac
3367
3368 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3369 An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3370 when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3371 contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3372 thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3373 is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3374 default value of this macro is zero.
3375 @end defmac
3376
3377 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3378 The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3379 languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 4KB/8KB
3380 with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
3381 8KB/12KB with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for most
3382 architectures and operating systems.
3383 @end defmac
3384
3385 The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3386 nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3387 in the opposite case.
3388
3389 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3390 The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
3391 instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3392 stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3393 checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3394 default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3395 systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3396 @end defmac
3397
3398 @defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3399 GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
3400 represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3401 space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3402 You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3403 use the default of four words.
3404 @end defmac
3405
3406 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3407 The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3408 fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3409 @option{-fstack-check}.
3410 GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3411 normally not need to override that default.
3412 @end defmac
3413
3414 @need 2000
3415 @node Frame Registers
3416 @subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3417
3418 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3419 This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3420
3421 @defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3422 The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3423 fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3424 the hardware determines which register this is.
3425 @end defmac
3426
3427 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3428 The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3429 access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3430 hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3431 choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3432 @end defmac
3433
3434 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3435 On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3436 offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3437 allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3438 between these two locations). On those machines, define
3439 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3440 be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3441 @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3442 used for the frame pointer.
3443
3444 You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3445 is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3446 the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3447 completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3448 definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3449 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3450 or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3451
3452 Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3453 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3454 @end defmac
3455
3456 @defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3457 The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3458 the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3459 frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3460 register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3461 wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3462 pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3463 @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3464 (@pxref{Elimination}).
3465 @end defmac
3466
3467 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3468 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3469 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3470 the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3471 == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3472 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3473 @end defmac
3474
3475 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3476 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3477 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3478 same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3479 ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3480 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3481 @end defmac
3482
3483 @defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3484 The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3485 access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3486 machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3487 pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3488 to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3489 @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3490
3491 Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3492 address from the stack.
3493 @end defmac
3494
3495 @defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3496 @defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3497 Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3498 register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3499 function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3500 number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3501 these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3502 not be defined.
3503
3504 The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3505
3506 If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3507 defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
3508 @end defmac
3509
3510 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN (const_tree @var{fndecl_or_type}, bool @var{incoming_p})
3511 This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3512 targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3513 nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3514 attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3515 those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3516
3517 The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
3518
3519 If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3520 provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3521 Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3522 from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3523 will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3524 @findex stack_pointer_rtx
3525 @findex frame_pointer_rtx
3526 @findex arg_pointer_rtx
3527 The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3528 @code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3529 to refer to those items.
3530 @end deftypefn
3531
3532 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3533 This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3534 saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3535 DWARF2 exception handling.
3536
3537 Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3538 exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3539 extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3540 in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3541 used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3542 routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3543 registers that are not call-saved.
3544
3545 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3546 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3547 @end defmac
3548
3549 @defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3550
3551 This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3552 for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3553
3554 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3555 @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3556 @end defmac
3557
3558 @defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3559
3560 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3561 is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3562 Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3563 column number to use instead.
3564
3565 See the PowerPC's SPE target for an example.
3566 @end defmac
3567
3568 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3569
3570 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3571 used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3572 debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3573 should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3574 @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3575
3576 @end defmac
3577
3578 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3579
3580 Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3581 that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3582 should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3583 .eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
3584 return @code{@var{regno}}.
3585
3586 @end defmac
3587
3588 @defmac REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3589
3590 Define this macro if the target stores register values as
3591 @code{_Unwind_Word} type in unwind context. It should be defined if
3592 target register size is larger than the size of @code{void *}. The
3593 default is to store register values as @code{void *} type.
3594
3595 @end defmac
3596
3597 @defmac ASSUME_EXTENDED_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3598
3599 Define this macro to be 1 if the target always uses extended unwind
3600 context with version, args_size and by_value fields. If it is undefined,
3601 it will be defined to 1 when @code{REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT} is
3602 defined and 0 otherwise.
3603
3604 @end defmac
3605
3606 @node Elimination
3607 @subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3608
3609 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3610 This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3611
3612 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED (void)
3613 This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3614 a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3615 value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
3616
3617 This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
3618 according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3619 constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3620 to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3621 Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3622 pointer.
3623
3624 In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3625 without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3626 automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3627 @code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} returns. You don't need to worry about
3628 them.
3629
3630 In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3631 register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3632 fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3633
3634 Default return value is @code{false}.
3635 @end deftypefn
3636
3637 @findex get_frame_size
3638 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET (@var{depth-var})
3639 A C statement to store in the variable @var{depth-var} the difference
3640 between the frame pointer and the stack pointer values immediately after
3641 the function prologue. The value would be computed from information
3642 such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3643 registers @code{regs_ever_live} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3644
3645 If @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is defined, this macro will be not be used and
3646 need not be defined. Otherwise, it must be defined even if
3647 @code{TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED} always returns true; in that
3648 case, you may set @var{depth-var} to anything.
3649 @end defmac
3650
3651 @defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3652 If defined, this macro specifies a table of register pairs used to
3653 eliminate unneeded registers that point into the stack frame. If it is not
3654 defined, the only elimination attempted by the compiler is to replace
3655 references to the frame pointer with references to the stack pointer.
3656
3657 The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3658 of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3659
3660 On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3661 the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3662 must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3663 replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3664 depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3665
3666 In this case, you might specify:
3667 @smallexample
3668 #define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3669 @{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3670 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3671 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3672 @end smallexample
3673
3674 Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3675 specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3676 @end defmac
3677
3678 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE (const int @var{from_reg}, const int @var{to_reg})
3679 This target hook should returns @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
3680 try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3681 @var{to_reg}. This target hook need only be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS}
3682 is defined, and will usually be @code{true}, since most of the cases
3683 preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3684 knows about.
3685
3686 Default return value is @code{true}.
3687 @end deftypefn
3688
3689 @defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3690 This macro is similar to @code{INITIAL_FRAME_POINTER_OFFSET}. It
3691 specifies the initial difference between the specified pair of
3692 registers. This macro must be defined if @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} is
3693 defined.
3694 @end defmac
3695
3696 @node Stack Arguments
3697 @subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3698 @cindex arguments on stack
3699 @cindex stack arguments
3700
3701 The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3702 on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3703 control passing certain arguments in registers.
3704
3705 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES (const_tree @var{fntype})
3706 This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3707 prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3708 passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3709 cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3710 The default is to not promote prototypes.
3711 @end deftypefn
3712
3713 @defmac PUSH_ARGS
3714 A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3715 outgoing arguments.
3716 If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3717 That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3718 allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3719 it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3720 @end defmac
3721
3722 @defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3723 A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3724 last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3725 defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3726 and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3727 @end defmac
3728
3729 @defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3730 A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3731 stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3732
3733 On some machines, the definition
3734
3735 @smallexample
3736 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3737 @end smallexample
3738
3739 @noindent
3740 will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3741 to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3742 alignment. Then the definition should be
3743
3744 @smallexample
3745 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3746 @end smallexample
3747
3748 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
3749 @end defmac
3750
3751 @findex outgoing_args_size
3752 @findex crtl->outgoing_args_size
3753 @defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3754 A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3755 will be computed and placed into
3756 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3757 onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3758 increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3759
3760 Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3761 is not proper.
3762 @end defmac
3763
3764 @defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3765 Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3766 allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3767 registers.
3768
3769 The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3770 arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3771 which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3772 The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3773 of the function.
3774
3775 This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3776 machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3777 which.
3778 @end defmac
3779 @c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3780 @c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3781
3782 @defmac INCOMING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3783 Like @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, but for incoming register arguments.
3784 Define this macro if space guaranteed when compiling a function body
3785 is different to space required when making a call, a situation that
3786 can arise with K&R style function definitions.
3787 @end defmac
3788
3789 @defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3790 Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3791 caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3792 when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3793 if the function called is a library function.
3794
3795 If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3796 whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3797 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}.
3798 @end defmac
3799
3800 @defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3801 Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3802 stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3803 @c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3804 @c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3805
3806 Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3807 stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3808 suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3809 stack in its natural location.
3810 @end defmac
3811
3812 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS (tree @var{fundecl}, tree @var{funtype}, int @var{size})
3813 This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3814 a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3815 and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
3816
3817 @var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3818 the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3819 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3820 From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3821
3822 @var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3823 describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3824 @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3825 From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3826 arguments (if known).
3827
3828 When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3829 will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3830 you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3831 by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3832 a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3833 in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3834
3835 @var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
3836 stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3837 argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3838
3839 On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
3840 of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
3841 calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3842 the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3843 convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3844 arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3845 nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3846 @var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3847 number of arguments.
3848 @end deftypefn
3849
3850 @defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3851 A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3852 pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3853 when compiling a function call.
3854
3855 @var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3856 have been accumulated.
3857
3858 On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3859 that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3860 that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
3861 call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3862 appropriate.
3863 @end defmac
3864
3865 @node Register Arguments
3866 @subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3867 @cindex arguments in registers
3868 @cindex registers arguments
3869
3870 This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3871 types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3872 the stack.
3873
3874 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
3875 Return an RTX indicating whether a function argument is passed in a
3876 register and if so, which register.
3877
3878 The arguments are @var{ca}, which summarizes all the previous
3879 arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
3880 the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
3881 (which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
3882 which is @code{true} for an ordinary argument and @code{false} for
3883 nameless arguments that correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called
3884 function's prototype. @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a
3885 syntax error has previously occurred.
3886
3887 The return value is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3888 register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the argument
3889 on the stack.
3890
3891 The return value can be a @code{const_int} which means argument is
3892 passed in a target specific slot with specified number. Target hooks
3893 should be used to store or load argument in such case. See
3894 @code{TARGET_STORE_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG} and @code{TARGET_LOAD_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG}
3895 for more information.
3896
3897 The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
3898 used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
3899 @code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
3900 @code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
3901 describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
3902 @code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3903 register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
3904 register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
3905 second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
3906 the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
3907 As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
3908 RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
3909 argument is also stored on the stack.
3910
3911 The last time this hook is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
3912 VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
3913 pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
3914
3915 @cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
3916 The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a
3917 machine where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to
3918 cause nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is
3919 done by making @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever
3920 @var{named} is @code{false}.
3921
3922 @cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
3923 @cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
3924 You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
3925 in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
3926 type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
3927 is not defined and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
3928 argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
3929 defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
3930 a register.
3931 @end deftypefn
3932
3933 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
3934 This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
3935 solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
3936 definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
3937 documentation.
3938 @end deftypefn
3939
3940 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
3941 Define this hook if the target machine has ``register windows'', so
3942 that the register in which a function sees an arguments is not
3943 necessarily the same as the one in which the caller passed the
3944 argument.
3945
3946 For such machines, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in
3947 which the caller passes the value, and
3948 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should be defined in a similar
3949 fashion to tell the function being called where the arguments will
3950 arrive.
3951
3952 If @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined,
3953 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} serves both purposes.
3954 @end deftypefn
3955
3956 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_PSEUDO_PIC_REG (void)
3957 This hook should return 1 in case pseudo register should be created
3958 for pic_offset_table_rtx during function expand.
3959 @end deftypefn
3960
3961 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_PIC_REG (void)
3962 Perform a target dependent initialization of pic_offset_table_rtx.
3963 This hook is called at the start of register allocation.
3964 @end deftypefn
3965
3966 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
3967 This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
3968 argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
3969 arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
3970 pushed on the stack.
3971
3972 On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
3973 registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
3974 first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
3975 on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
3976 structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
3977 in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
3978 compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
3979
3980 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
3981 register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
3982 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
3983 @end deftypefn
3984
3985 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
3986 This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
3987 position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
3988 predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
3989 passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
3990
3991 If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
3992 pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
3993 The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
3994 to that type.
3995 @end deftypefn
3996
3997 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
3998 The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
3999 known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
4000 function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
4001 by the caller.
4002
4003 For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
4004 determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
4005 not be generated.
4006
4007 The default version of this hook always returns false.
4008 @end deftypefn
4009
4010 @defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
4011 A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument
4012 of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some
4013 target machines, the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number
4014 of bytes of argument so far.
4015
4016 There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4017 arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4018 variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4019 arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4020 @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4021 should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
4022 @end defmac
4023
4024 @defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4025 If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4026 function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4027 created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4028 reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4029 If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4030 @var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4031 @end defmac
4032
4033 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
4034 A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4035 @var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4036 variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4037 is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4038 the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4039 For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4040 declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4041 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
4042 being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4043 arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4044 parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
4045 @var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
4046
4047 When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4048 @var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4049 contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4050 an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4051 macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4052 never both of them at once.
4053 @end defmac
4054
4055 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
4056 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4057 it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4058 @code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4059 is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
4060 0)} is used instead.
4061 @end defmac
4062
4063 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
4064 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4065 finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4066 undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4067
4068 The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
4069 with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
4070 argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4071 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4072 @c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4073 @c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
4074 @end defmac
4075
4076 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4077 This hook updates the summarizer variable pointed to by @var{ca} to
4078 advance past an argument in the argument list. The values @var{mode},
4079 @var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument. Once this is done,
4080 the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing the @emph{following}
4081 argument with @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
4082
4083 This hook need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
4084 on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4085 used for arguments without any special help.
4086 @end deftypefn
4087
4088 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4089 If defined, a C expression that is the number of bytes to add to the
4090 offset of the argument passed in memory. This is needed for the SPU,
4091 which passes @code{char} and @code{short} arguments in the preferred
4092 slot that is in the middle of the quad word instead of starting at the
4093 top.
4094 @end defmac
4095
4096 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type})
4097 If defined, a C expression which determines whether, and in which direction,
4098 to pad out an argument with extra space. The value should be of type
4099 @code{enum direction}: either @code{upward} to pad above the argument,
4100 @code{downward} to pad below, or @code{none} to inhibit padding.
4101
4102 The @emph{amount} of padding is not controlled by this macro, but by the
4103 target hook @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY}. It is
4104 always just enough to reach the next multiple of that boundary.
4105
4106 This macro has a default definition which is right for most systems.
4107 For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4108 big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4109 constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
4110 @end defmac
4111
4112 @defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
4113 If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4114 implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
4115 next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4116 controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4117 arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
4118 @end defmac
4119
4120 @defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4121 Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4122 memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4123 macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4124 machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4125 @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4126 registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4127 a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4128 required.
4129 @end defmac
4130
4131 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4132 This hook returns the alignment boundary, in bits, of an argument
4133 with the specified mode and type. The default hook returns
4134 @code{PARM_BOUNDARY} for all arguments.
4135 @end deftypefn
4136
4137 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4138 Normally, the size of an argument is rounded up to @code{PARM_BOUNDARY},
4139 which is the default value for this hook. You can define this hook to
4140 return a different value if an argument size must be rounded to a larger
4141 value.
4142 @end deftypefn
4143
4144 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4145 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4146 register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4147 @emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4148 the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4149 used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4150 stack.
4151 @end defmac
4152
4153 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG (const_tree @var{type})
4154 This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4155 as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4156 arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4157 to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4158 AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4159 registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4160 point register.
4161
4162 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4163 false.
4164 @end deftypefn
4165
4166 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST (void)
4167 This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4168 The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4169 @end deftypefn
4170
4171 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P (int @var{idx}, const char **@var{pname}, tree *@var{ptree})
4172 This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4173 to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4174 variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
4175 to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
4176 variable.
4177 The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
4178 this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4179 internal type.
4180 If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4181 Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4182 macro to iterate through all types.
4183 @end deftypefn
4184
4185 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST (tree @var{fndecl})
4186 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4187 @var{fndecl}.
4188 The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4189 @end deftypefn
4190
4191 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE (tree @var{type})
4192 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4193 type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4194 @code{NULL_TREE}.
4195 @end deftypefn
4196
4197 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR (tree @var{valist}, tree @var{type}, gimple_seq *@var{pre_p}, gimple_seq *@var{post_p})
4198 This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4199 @code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4200 arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4201 @code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
4202 @end deftypefn
4203
4204 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode})
4205 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4206 with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4207 hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4208 @end deftypefn
4209
4210 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REF_MAY_ALIAS_ERRNO (struct ao_ref *@var{ref})
4211 Define this to return nonzero if the memory reference @var{ref} may alias with the system C library errno location. The default version of this hook assumes the system C library errno location is either a declaration of type int or accessed by dereferencing a pointer to int.
4212 @end deftypefn
4213
4214 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
4215 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4216 insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4217 considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4218 must work.
4219
4220 The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4221 required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4222 Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4223 code in @file{optabs.c}.
4224 @end deftypefn
4225
4226 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
4227 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4228 insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4229 must have move patterns for this mode.
4230 @end deftypefn
4231
4232 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{nelems})
4233 Return true if GCC should try to use a scalar mode to store an array
4234 of @var{nelems} elements, given that each element has mode @var{mode}.
4235 Returning true here overrides the usual @code{MAX_FIXED_MODE} limit
4236 and allows GCC to use any defined integer mode.
4237
4238 One use of this hook is to support vector load and store operations
4239 that operate on several homogeneous vectors. For example, ARM NEON
4240 has operations like:
4241
4242 @smallexample
4243 int8x8x3_t vld3_s8 (const int8_t *)
4244 @end smallexample
4245
4246 where the return type is defined as:
4247
4248 @smallexample
4249 typedef struct int8x8x3_t
4250 @{
4251 int8x8_t val[3];
4252 @} int8x8x3_t;
4253 @end smallexample
4254
4255 If this hook allows @code{val} to have a scalar mode, then
4256 @code{int8x8x3_t} can have the same mode. GCC can then store
4257 @code{int8x8x3_t}s in registers rather than forcing them onto the stack.
4258 @end deftypefn
4259
4260 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBGCC_FLOATING_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
4261 Define this to return nonzero if libgcc provides support for the
4262 floating-point mode @var{mode}, which is known to pass
4263 @code{TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P}. The default version of this
4264 hook returns true for all of @code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode},
4265 @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode}, if such modes exist.
4266 @end deftypefn
4267
4268 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
4269 Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4270 small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4271 @var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4272 in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4273 In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4274 for any mode.
4275
4276 On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4277 insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4278 to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4279 if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4280 insn.
4281
4282 Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4283 in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4284 the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4285 classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4286 registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4287 registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4288 SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4289 strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4290 machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4291
4292 The default version of this hook returns false for any mode. It is always
4293 safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4294 unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4295 that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4296 to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4297 of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4298 @end deftypefn
4299
4300 @node Scalar Return
4301 @subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4302 @cindex return values in registers
4303 @cindex values, returned by functions
4304 @cindex scalars, returned as values
4305
4306 This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4307 values---values that can fit in registers.
4308
4309 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE (const_tree @var{ret_type}, const_tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing})
4310
4311 Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4312 returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
4313 representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
4314 representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4315 function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4316 compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4317 Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4318 a function returns a value.
4319
4320 On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4321 (Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4322 place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4323 @code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4324 The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
4325 multiple places. See @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
4326 @code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4327 location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4328 the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4329 that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4330 port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4331 @samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
4332
4333 If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4334 the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4335 @var{valtype} is a scalar type.
4336
4337 If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4338 node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4339 pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4340 convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4341 known.
4342
4343 Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4344 which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4345 the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4346 different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4347
4348 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4349 aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
4350 @code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
4351 @end deftypefn
4352
4353 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4354 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4355 a new target instead.
4356 @end defmac
4357
4358 @defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
4359 A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
4360 function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
4361
4362 Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4363 support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4364 specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4365 compiled.
4366 @end defmac
4367
4368 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{fun})
4369 Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
4370 function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
4371
4372 The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
4373 library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
4374 representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4375
4376 If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4377 @end deftypefn
4378
4379 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4380 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4381 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4382
4383 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4384 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4385 recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4386 suffices:
4387
4388 @smallexample
4389 #define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
4390 @end smallexample
4391
4392 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4393 function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4394 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4395
4396 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4397 for a new target instead.
4398 @end defmac
4399
4400 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (const unsigned int @var{regno})
4401 A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4402 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4403
4404 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4405 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4406 recognized by this target hook.
4407
4408 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4409 function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4410 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4411
4412 If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4413 @end deftypefn
4414
4415 @defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
4416 Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4417 need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4418 saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
4419 @end defmac
4420
4421 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OMIT_STRUCT_RETURN_REG
4422 Normally, when a function returns a structure by memory, the address
4423 is passed as an invisible pointer argument, but the compiler also
4424 arranges to return the address from the function like it would a normal
4425 pointer return value. Define this to true if that behaviour is
4426 undesirable on your target.
4427 @end deftypevr
4428
4429 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB (const_tree @var{type})
4430 This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4431 at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4432 padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4433 is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4434
4435 Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4436 be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4437 or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
4438 4-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4439 @code{SImode} rtx.
4440 @end deftypefn
4441
4442 @node Aggregate Return
4443 @subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4444 @cindex aggregates as return values
4445 @cindex large return values
4446 @cindex returning aggregate values
4447 @cindex structure value address
4448
4449 When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
4450 cases), the value is not returned according to
4451 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4452 caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4453 should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4454 address}.
4455
4456 This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4457 memory.
4458
4459 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY (const_tree @var{type}, const_tree @var{fntype})
4460 This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4461 function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4462 Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4463 will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4464 libcalls.
4465
4466 Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
4467 by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
4468 takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
4469 possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
4470 definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4471 values, and 0 otherwise.
4472
4473 Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
4474 be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4475 to indicate this.
4476 @end deftypefn
4477
4478 @defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
4479 Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4480 in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
4481 only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
4482 If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
4483 and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4484 target hook.
4485
4486 If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
4487 @end defmac
4488
4489 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{incoming})
4490 This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4491 address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4492 passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
4493 be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4494 hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4495 argument.
4496
4497 On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4498 is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4499 caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4500 be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
4501 @var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4502 the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
4503 the caller.
4504
4505 If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
4506 stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4507 @var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
4508 structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
4509 to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
4510 @end deftypefn
4511
4512 @defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
4513 Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4514 for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4515 the address of a static variable containing the value.
4516
4517 Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4518 pass an address to the subroutine.
4519
4520 This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4521 nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
4522 @end defmac
4523
4524 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE (int @var{regno})
4525 This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw return registers in @code{__builtin_return}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4526 @end deftypefn
4527
4528 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE (int @var{regno})
4529 This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw argument registers in @code{__builtin_apply_args}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4530 @end deftypefn
4531
4532 @node Caller Saves
4533 @subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4534
4535 If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
4536 makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4537 must live across calls.
4538
4539 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4540 A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4541 of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4542 @var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4543 returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4544 will select the smallest suitable mode.
4545 @end defmac
4546
4547 @node Function Entry
4548 @subsection Function Entry and Exit
4549 @cindex function entry and exit
4550 @cindex prologue
4551 @cindex epilogue
4552
4553 This section describes the macros that output function entry
4554 (@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4555
4556 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4557 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4558 function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4559 initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4560 saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4561 local variables. @var{size} is an integer. @var{file} is a stdio
4562 stream to which the assembler code should be output.
4563
4564 The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4565 macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4566
4567 @findex regs_ever_live
4568 To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4569 @code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4570 @var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4571 prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4572 call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4573 @code{regs_ever_live}.)
4574
4575 On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4576 not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4577 they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4578 appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4579 registers are used in the function.
4580
4581 @findex frame_pointer_needed
4582 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4583 function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4584 pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4585 frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4586 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4587 time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4588
4589 The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4590 required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4591 listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4592 order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4593 stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4594 the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4595 for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4596 compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4597 or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4598 need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4599 @end deftypefn
4600
4601 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4602 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4603 prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4604 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4605 emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4606 @end deftypefn
4607
4608 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4609 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4610 epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4611 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4612 emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4613 @end deftypefn
4614
4615 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
4616 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4617 function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4618 registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4619 called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4620 same arguments as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4621 registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4622 @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4623
4624 On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4625 of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4626 instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4627 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4628
4629 Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4630 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4631 switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4632 define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4633 target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4634 condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4635
4636 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4637 function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4638 two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4639 is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4640 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4641 a function that needs a frame pointer.
4642
4643 Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4644 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4645 The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4646 function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4647
4648 On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4649 others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4650 given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4651 number of arguments.
4652
4653 @findex pops_args
4654 @findex crtl->args.pops_args
4655 Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4656 functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4657 needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4658 function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4659 @code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
4660 @end deftypefn
4661
4662 @itemize @bullet
4663 @item
4664 @findex pretend_args_size
4665 @findex crtl->args.pretend_args_size
4666 A region of @code{crtl->args.pretend_args_size} bytes of
4667 uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4668 stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4669 if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4670 arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4671 yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4672 region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4673 registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4674 features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4675
4676 @item
4677 An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4678 The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4679 the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4680 machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4681 in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4682 a save area.
4683
4684 @item
4685 A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4686 boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4687 this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4688 save area closer to the top of the stack.
4689
4690 @item
4691 @cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4692 Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4693 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4694 argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4695 @end itemize
4696
4697 @defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4698 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4699 instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4700 pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4701 adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4702 default is 0.
4703
4704 Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4705 frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4706 stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4707 compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4708 @end defmac
4709
4710 @defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4711 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4712 used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
4713 pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
4714 @end defmac
4715
4716 @defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
4717 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4718 used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4719 on entry to an exception edge.
4720 @end defmac
4721
4722 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, tree @var{function})
4723 A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4724 function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4725 inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4726 adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4727 the real function.
4728
4729 First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4730 contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4731 contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4732 in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4733 e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
4734 all other incoming arguments.
4735
4736 Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4737 made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4738 adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4739
4740 @smallexample
4741 p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4742 @end smallexample
4743
4744 After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4745 @code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4746 not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4747 return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4748
4749 The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4750 the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
4751 of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4752 and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4753
4754 The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4755 have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4756 some targets, but probably not.
4757
4758 If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4759 front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4760 @var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4761 not support varargs.
4762 @end deftypefn
4763
4764 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (const_tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, const_tree @var{function})
4765 A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4766 to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4767 arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4768 generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4769 previously exposed.
4770 @end deftypefn
4771
4772 @node Profiling
4773 @subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4774 @cindex profiling, code generation
4775
4776 These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4777
4778 @defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4779 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4780 assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4781
4782 @findex mcount
4783 The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4784 your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
4785 compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4786 compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4787
4788 Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4789 variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4790 @samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4791 the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4792 @end defmac
4793
4794 @defmac PROFILE_HOOK
4795 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4796 code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4797 not support profiling.
4798 @end defmac
4799
4800 @defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4801 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4802 @code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4803 allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4804 implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4805 @var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4806 @end defmac
4807
4808 @defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4809 Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4810 the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4811 @end defmac
4812
4813 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_KEEP_LEAF_WHEN_PROFILED (void)
4814 This target hook returns true if the target wants the leaf flag for the current function to stay true even if it calls mcount. This might make sense for targets using the leaf flag only to determine whether a stack frame needs to be generated or not and for which the call to mcount is generated before the function prologue.
4815 @end deftypefn
4816
4817 @node Tail Calls
4818 @subsection Permitting tail calls
4819 @cindex tail calls
4820
4821 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{exp})
4822 True if it is OK to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4823 call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4824 or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4825
4826 It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4827 tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4828 during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4829 as the @code{sibcall} md pattern can not fail, or fall over to a
4830 ``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4831 may vary greatly between different architectures.
4832 @end deftypefn
4833
4834 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY (bitmap @var{regs})
4835 Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
4836 function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
4837 cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
4838 registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
4839 TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
4840 FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
4841 @end deftypefn
4842
4843 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_UP_BY_PROLOGUE (struct hard_reg_set_container *@var{})
4844 This hook should add additional registers that are computed by the prologue to the hard regset for shrink-wrapping optimization purposes.
4845 @end deftypefn
4846
4847 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WARN_FUNC_RETURN (tree)
4848 True if a function's return statements should be checked for matching the function's return type. This includes checking for falling off the end of a non-void function. Return false if no such check should be made.
4849 @end deftypefn
4850
4851 @node Stack Smashing Protection
4852 @subsection Stack smashing protection
4853 @cindex stack smashing protection
4854
4855 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD (void)
4856 This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
4857 for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
4858 runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
4859 that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
4860 variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
4861
4862 The default version of this hook creates a variable called
4863 @samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4864 @end deftypefn
4865
4866 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL (void)
4867 This hook returns a @code{CALL_EXPR} that alerts the runtime that the
4868 stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
4869 involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
4870
4871 The default version of this hook invokes a function called
4872 @samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
4873 normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4874 @end deftypefn
4875
4876 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK (bool @var{report}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
4877 Whether this target supports splitting the stack when the options described in @var{opts} have been passed. This is called after options have been parsed, so the target may reject splitting the stack in some configurations. The default version of this hook returns false. If @var{report} is true, this function may issue a warning or error; if @var{report} is false, it must simply return a value
4878 @end deftypefn
4879
4880 @node Miscellaneous Register Hooks
4881 @subsection Miscellaneous register hooks
4882 @cindex miscellaneous register hooks
4883
4884 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALL_FUSAGE_CONTAINS_NON_CALLEE_CLOBBERS
4885 Set to true if each call that binds to a local definition explicitly
4886 clobbers or sets all non-fixed registers modified by performing the call.
4887 That is, by the call pattern itself, or by code that might be inserted by the
4888 linker (e.g. stubs, veneers, branch islands), but not including those
4889 modifiable by the callee. The affected registers may be mentioned explicitly
4890 in the call pattern, or included as clobbers in CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE.
4891 The default version of this hook is set to false. The purpose of this hook
4892 is to enable the fipa-ra optimization.
4893 @end deftypevr
4894
4895 @node Varargs
4896 @section Implementing the Varargs Macros
4897 @cindex varargs implementation
4898
4899 GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
4900 @code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
4901 on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
4902 varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
4903 conditionals to include it.
4904
4905 ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
4906 the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
4907 implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
4908 to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
4909 @code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
4910 supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
4911
4912 However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
4913 the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
4914 below.
4915
4916 @defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
4917 Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
4918 that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
4919 versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
4920 you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
4921
4922 On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
4923 control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
4924 other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
4925 found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
4926
4927 Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
4928 beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
4929 @code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
4930 This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
4931 to use them for its own purposes.
4932 @c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
4933 @c 10feb93
4934 @end defmac
4935
4936 @defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
4937 This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
4938 argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
4939 returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
4940 argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
4941 fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
4942 verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
4943 of the current function.
4944 @end defmac
4945
4946 @defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
4947 Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
4948 passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
4949 has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
4950 specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
4951 with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
4952
4953 @code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
4954 considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
4955 kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
4956
4957 The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
4958 interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
4959 @end defmac
4960
4961 These machine description macros help implement varargs:
4962
4963 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS (void)
4964 If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
4965 @code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
4966 beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
4967 return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
4968 to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
4969 @end deftypefn
4970
4971 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS (cumulative_args_t @var{args_so_far}, machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
4972 This target hook offers an alternative to using
4973 @code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
4974 @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
4975 register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
4976 have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
4977 use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
4978 pass all their arguments on the stack.
4979
4980 The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
4981 structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
4982 named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
4983 last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
4984
4985 The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
4986 argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
4987 store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
4988 variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
4989 store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
4990 frame.
4991
4992 Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
4993 compile time without knowing their data types,
4994 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
4995 have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
4996 for all data types.
4997
4998 If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
4999 arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
5000 happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
5001 end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
5002 not generate any instructions in this case.
5003 @end deftypefn
5004
5005 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
5006 Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
5007 argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
5008
5009 This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
5010 is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
5011 @code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5012 arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
5013 but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
5014 then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
5015 except the last are treated as named.
5016
5017 You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
5018 @end deftypefn
5019
5020 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CALL_ARGS (rtx, @var{tree})
5021 While generating RTL for a function call, this target hook is invoked once
5022 for each argument passed to the function, either a register returned by
5023 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} or a memory location. It is called just
5024 before the point where argument registers are stored. The type of the
5025 function to be called is also passed as the second argument; it is
5026 @code{NULL_TREE} for libcalls. The @code{TARGET_END_CALL_ARGS} hook is
5027 invoked just after the code to copy the return reg has been emitted.
5028 This functionality can be used to perform special setup of call argument
5029 registers if a target needs it.
5030 For functions without arguments, the hook is called once with @code{pc_rtx}
5031 passed instead of an argument register.
5032 Most ports do not need to implement anything for this hook.
5033 @end deftypefn
5034
5035 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_END_CALL_ARGS (void)
5036 This target hook is invoked while generating RTL for a function call,
5037 just after the point where the return reg is copied into a pseudo. It
5038 signals that all the call argument and return registers for the just
5039 emitted call are now no longer in use.
5040 Most ports do not need to implement anything for this hook.
5041 @end deftypefn
5042
5043 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
5044 If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
5045 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5046 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5047 defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
5048 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
5049 Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5050 @end deftypefn
5051
5052 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LOAD_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG (rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{arg}, rtx @var{slot_no})
5053 This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to load bounds of
5054 @var{arg} passed in @var{slot}. Expand pass uses this hook in case
5055 bounds of @var{arg} are not passed in register. If @var{slot} is a
5056 memory, then bounds are loaded as for regular pointer loaded from
5057 memory. If @var{slot} is not a memory then @var{slot_no} is an integer
5058 constant holding number of the target dependent special slot which
5059 should be used to obtain bounds. Hook returns RTX holding loaded bounds.
5060 @end deftypefn
5061
5062 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_STORE_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG (rtx @var{arg}, rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{bounds}, rtx @var{slot_no})
5063 This hook is used by expand pass to emit insns to store @var{bounds} of
5064 @var{arg} passed in @var{slot}. Expand pass uses this hook in case
5065 @var{bounds} of @var{arg} are not passed in register. If @var{slot} is a
5066 memory, then @var{bounds} are stored as for regular pointer stored in
5067 memory. If @var{slot} is not a memory then @var{slot_no} is an integer
5068 constant holding number of the target dependent special slot which
5069 should be used to store @var{bounds}.
5070 @end deftypefn
5071
5072 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LOAD_RETURNED_BOUNDS (rtx @var{slot})
5073 This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to load bounds
5074 returned by function call in @var{slot}. Hook returns RTX holding
5075 loaded bounds.
5076 @end deftypefn
5077
5078 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_STORE_RETURNED_BOUNDS (rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{bounds})
5079 This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to store @var{bounds}
5080 returned by function call into @var{slot}.
5081 @end deftypefn
5082
5083 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_CHKP_FUNCTION_VALUE_BOUNDS (const_tree @var{ret_type}, const_tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing})
5084 Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
5085 returns bounds for returned pointers. Arguments meaning is similar to
5086 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE}.
5087 @end deftypefn
5088
5089 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARG_BOUNDS (cumulative_args_t @var{args_so_far}, enum machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
5090 Use it to store bounds for anonymous register arguments stored
5091 into the stack. Arguments meaning is similar to
5092 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}.
5093 @end deftypefn
5094
5095 @node Trampolines
5096 @section Trampolines for Nested Functions
5097 @cindex trampolines for nested functions
5098 @cindex nested functions, trampolines for
5099
5100 A @dfn{trampoline} is a small piece of code that is created at run time
5101 when the address of a nested function is taken. It normally resides on
5102 the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function. These macros
5103 tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and initialize a
5104 trampoline.
5105
5106 The instructions in the trampoline must do two things: load a constant
5107 address into the static chain register, and jump to the real address of
5108 the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k, this requires
5109 two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the two addresses
5110 exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands. On RISC
5111 machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a register in
5112 two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate immediate
5113 operands.
5114
5115 The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5116 parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5117 immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5118 simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5119 proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5120 may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5121 separately.
5122
5123 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE (FILE *@var{f})
5124 This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5125 on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5126 the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5127 label---the label is taken care of automatically.
5128
5129 If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5130 for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
5131 code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5132 to generate it on the spot.
5133 @end deftypefn
5134
5135 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
5136 Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5137 (@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
5138 @end defmac
5139
5140 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
5141 A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
5142 @end defmac
5143
5144 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
5145 Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5146
5147 If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
5148 is used for aligning trampolines.
5149 @end defmac
5150
5151 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT (rtx @var{m_tramp}, tree @var{fndecl}, rtx @var{static_chain})
5152 This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5153 @var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5154 is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
5155 RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5156 when it is called.
5157
5158 If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5159 first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5160 from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
5161 Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
5162 trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5163 to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
5164
5165 If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
5166 enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
5167 initializing the trampoline proper.
5168 @end deftypefn
5169
5170 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS (rtx @var{addr})
5171 This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5172 the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5173 memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5174 the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5175 address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5176 be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5177 If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5178 @end deftypefn
5179
5180 Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5181 separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5182 fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5183 jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5184
5185 Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5186 the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5187 make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5188 subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5189 latter makes initialization faster.
5190
5191 To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
5192 the following macro.
5193
5194 @defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
5195 If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
5196 cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5197 typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5198 @var{end} are both pointer expressions.
5199 @end defmac
5200
5201 To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5202 you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5203 cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5204 beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5205 its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5206
5207 @defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
5208 Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5209 work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
5210 which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
5211 @code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5212
5213 If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5214 C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5215 special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5216 statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5217 global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5218 special assembler code.
5219 @end defmac
5220
5221 @node Library Calls
5222 @section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5223 @cindex library subroutine names
5224 @cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5225
5226 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5227 Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5228
5229 @defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
5230 This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5231 expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
5232 provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
5233 are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
5234 @end defmac
5235
5236 @findex set_optab_libfunc
5237 @findex init_one_libfunc
5238 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS (void)
5239 This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5240 existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5241 @code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5242 @code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5243 library routines.
5244
5245 The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5246 @end deftypefn
5247
5248 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX
5249 If false (the default), internal library routines start with two
5250 underscores. If set to true, these routines start with @code{__gnu_}
5251 instead. E.g., @code{__muldi3} changes to @code{__gnu_muldi3}. This
5252 currently only affects functions defined in @file{libgcc2.c}. If this
5253 is set to true, the @file{tm.h} file must also
5254 @code{#define LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX}.
5255 @end deftypevr
5256
5257 @defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
5258 This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5259 implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5260 mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5261 return a tristate.
5262
5263 GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5264 comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5265 don't need to define this macro.
5266 @end defmac
5267
5268 @defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5269 This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5270 functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5271 operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5272 and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
5273 If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
5274 @minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
5275 in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5276 @end defmac
5277
5278 @defmac TARGET_HAS_NO_HW_DIVIDE
5279 This macro should be defined if the target has no hardware divide
5280 instructions. If this macro is defined, GCC will use an algorithm which
5281 make use of simple logical and arithmetic operations for 64-bit
5282 division. If the macro is not defined, GCC will use an algorithm which
5283 make use of a 64-bit by 32-bit divide primitive.
5284 @end defmac
5285
5286 @cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
5287 @findex matherr
5288 @defmac TARGET_EDOM
5289 The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
5290 expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
5291 deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5292 @file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5293 system.
5294
5295 If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5296 domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5297 error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5298 there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5299 that @code{matherr} is used normally.
5300 @end defmac
5301
5302 @cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
5303 @defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
5304 Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5305 refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5306 @code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5307 macro, a reasonable default is used.
5308 @end defmac
5309
5310 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBC_HAS_FUNCTION (enum function_class @var{fn_class})
5311 This hook determines whether a function from a class of functions
5312 @var{fn_class} is present at the runtime.
5313 @end deftypefn
5314
5315 @defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
5316 Set this macro to 1 to use the "NeXT" Objective-C message sending conventions
5317 by default. This calling convention involves passing the object, the selector
5318 and the method arguments all at once to the method-lookup library function.
5319 This is the usual setting when targeting Darwin/Mac OS X systems, which have
5320 the NeXT runtime installed.
5321
5322 If the macro is set to 0, the "GNU" Objective-C message sending convention
5323 will be used by default. This convention passes just the object and the
5324 selector to the method-lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5325
5326 In either case, it remains possible to select code-generation for the alternate
5327 scheme, by means of compiler command line switches.
5328 @end defmac
5329
5330 @node Addressing Modes
5331 @section Addressing Modes
5332 @cindex addressing modes
5333
5334 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5335 This is about addressing modes.
5336
5337 @defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5338 @defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5339 @defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5340 @defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
5341 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
5342 pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
5343 @end defmac
5344
5345 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5346 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
5347 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5348 post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5349 the size of the memory operand.
5350 @end defmac
5351
5352 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5353 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
5354 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5355 post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
5356 @end defmac
5357
5358 @defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
5359 A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
5360 is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5361 @code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5362 is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
5363 constant addresses are supported.
5364 @end defmac
5365
5366 @defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5367 @code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5368 accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5369 known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5370 expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5371 @code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5372 @end defmac
5373
5374 @defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
5375 A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5376 memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
5377 the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
5378 accept.
5379 @end defmac
5380
5381 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, bool @var{strict})
5382 A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5383 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5384
5385 Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
5386 non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
5387 desired by the caller.
5388
5389 The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5390 that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5391 considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5392 kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5393 must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5394 up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5395 register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5396 if the array holds @code{-1}.
5397
5398 The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5399 accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5400 register is required.
5401
5402 Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5403 and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5404 constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5405 specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5406 recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5407
5408 Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5409 sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5410 @code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5411 naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5412 be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5413
5414 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
5415 On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5416 the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
5417 target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5418 into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
5419 @code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5420 @code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5421 Format}.
5422
5423 @cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5424 Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5425 this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5426 has this syntax:
5427
5428 @example
5429 #define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5430 @end example
5431
5432 @noindent
5433 and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5434 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5435
5436 @findex REG_OK_STRICT
5437 Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5438 macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
5439 @code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
5440 that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5441
5442 Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5443 files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5444 @end deftypefn
5445
5446 @defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5447 A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5448 character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5449 letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
5450 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
5451 support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5452 semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5453 preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5454 @code{'m'} constraint.
5455 @end defmac
5456
5457 @defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
5458 A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5459 or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
5460 can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5461 @code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
5462
5463 It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5464 that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5465
5466 The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
5467 a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
5468 @end defmac
5469
5470 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, machine_mode @var{mode})
5471 This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5472 operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5473 address.
5474
5475 @findex break_out_memory_refs
5476 @var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5477 and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5478 @var{x}.
5479
5480 The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
5481 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5482 should return the new @var{x}.
5483
5484 It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address,
5485 with the exception of native TLS addresses (@pxref{Emulated TLS}).
5486 The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, if
5487 the target supports only emulated TLS, it
5488 is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5489 a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5490 strategy can generate better code.
5491 @end deftypefn
5492
5493 @defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5494 A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5495 that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5496 @var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5497 It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5498 performance reasons.
5499
5500 For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5501 reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5502 registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5503 processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5504 needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
5505 @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5506 generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5507 be shared.
5508
5509 @emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5510 to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5511 and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5512 of reload internals.
5513
5514 @emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5515 previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5516 then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5517
5518 @findex push_reload
5519 The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5520 need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5521 suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5522
5523 The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5524 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5525 should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5526 This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5527 @code{push_reload}.
5528
5529 @findex strict_memory_address_p
5530 The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5531 the address has become legitimate.
5532
5533 @findex copy_rtx
5534 If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5535 this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
5536 single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5537 top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5538 It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5539 address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5540 @end defmac
5541
5542 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P (const_rtx @var{addr}, addr_space_t @var{addrspace})
5543 This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} in address
5544 space @var{addrspace} can have
5545 different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5546 reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5547 but not others.
5548
5549 Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5550 effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5551 of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5552 addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5553
5554 You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5555
5556 The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5557 @end deftypefn
5558
5559 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5560 This hook returns true if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for a
5561 @var{mode}-mode immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5562 @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this.
5563
5564 The default definition returns true.
5565 @end deftypefn
5566
5567 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x})
5568 This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5569 @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5570 macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5571 references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5572 addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5573 the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5574 into their original form.
5575 @end deftypefn
5576
5577 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CONST_NOT_OK_FOR_DEBUG_P (rtx @var{x})
5578 This hook should return true if @var{x} should not be emitted into
5579 debug sections.
5580 @end deftypefn
5581
5582 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5583 This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
5584 should not) be spilled to the constant pool. @var{mode} is the mode
5585 of @var{x}.
5586
5587 The default version of this hook returns false.
5588
5589 The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5590 deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5591 from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5592 holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5593 of TLS symbols for various targets.
5594 @end deftypefn
5595
5596 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{x})
5597 This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5598 be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5599 of @var{x}.
5600
5601 The default version returns false for all constants.
5602 @end deftypefn
5603
5604 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_DECL_P (const_tree @var{decl})
5605 This hook should return true if pool entries for @var{decl} should
5606 be placed in an @code{object_block} structure.
5607
5608 The default version returns true for all decls.
5609 @end deftypefn
5610
5611 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL (tree @var{fndecl})
5612 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements the
5613 reciprocal of the machine-specific builtin function @var{fndecl}, or
5614 @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5615 @end deftypefn
5616
5617 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD (void)
5618 This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5619 address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
5620 used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
5621 @var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5622
5623 The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
5624 @var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5625 the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5626 @code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5627 two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5628 @var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5629 the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5630 from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
5631 @var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5632 @var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
5633 @var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5634
5635 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5636 to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5637 use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5638 @code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
5639 should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
5640 described above.
5641 If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5642 the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
5643 log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
5644 @end deftypefn
5645
5646 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST (enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{type_of_cost}, tree @var{vectype}, int @var{misalign})
5647 Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
5648 For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
5649 misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
5650 @end deftypefn
5651
5652 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE (const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{is_packed})
5653 Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given type.
5654 @end deftypefn
5655
5656 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VEC_PERM_CONST_OK (machine_mode, const unsigned char *@var{sel})
5657 Return true if a vector created for @code{vec_perm_const} is valid.
5658 @end deftypefn
5659
5660 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION (unsigned @var{code}, tree @var{dest_type}, tree @var{src_type})
5661 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
5662 input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
5663 The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5664 specifies how the conversion is to be applied
5665 (truncation, rounding, etc.).
5666
5667 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5668 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5669 conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5670 @end deftypefn
5671
5672 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION (unsigned @var{code}, tree @var{vec_type_out}, tree @var{vec_type_in})
5673 This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5674 vectorized variant of the function with the @code{combined_fn} code
5675 @var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5676 The return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5677 @var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5678 @end deftypefn
5679
5680 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MD_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{vec_type_out}, tree @var{vec_type_in})
5681 This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5682 vectorized variant of target built-in function @code{fndecl}. The
5683 return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5684 @var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5685 @end deftypefn
5686
5687 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, int @var{misalignment}, bool @var{is_packed})
5688 This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5689 store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
5690 parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
5691 the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
5692 parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
5693 @end deftypefn
5694
5695 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode})
5696 This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
5697 mode @var{mode}. The default is
5698 equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
5699 transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
5700 @end deftypefn
5701
5702 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES (void)
5703 This hook should return a mask of sizes that should be iterated over
5704 after trying to autovectorize using the vector size derived from the
5705 mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
5706 The default is zero which means to not iterate over other vector sizes.
5707 @end deftypefn
5708
5709 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_VECTORIZE_GET_MASK_MODE (unsigned @var{nunits}, unsigned @var{length})
5710 This hook returns mode to be used for a mask to be used for a vector
5711 of specified @var{length} with @var{nunits} elements. By default an integer
5712 vector mode of a proper size is returned.
5713 @end deftypefn
5714
5715 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST (struct loop *@var{loop_info})
5716 This hook should initialize target-specific data structures in preparation for modeling the costs of vectorizing a loop or basic block. The default allocates three unsigned integers for accumulating costs for the prologue, body, and epilogue of the loop or basic block. If @var{loop_info} is non-NULL, it identifies the loop being vectorized; otherwise a single block is being vectorized.
5717 @end deftypefn
5718
5719 @deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_VECTORIZE_ADD_STMT_COST (void *@var{data}, int @var{count}, enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{kind}, struct _stmt_vec_info *@var{stmt_info}, int @var{misalign}, enum vect_cost_model_location @var{where})
5720 This hook should update the target-specific @var{data} in response to adding @var{count} copies of the given @var{kind} of statement to a loop or basic block. The default adds the builtin vectorizer cost for the copies of the statement to the accumulator specified by @var{where}, (the prologue, body, or epilogue) and returns the amount added. The return value should be viewed as a tentative cost that may later be revised.
5721 @end deftypefn
5722
5723 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_FINISH_COST (void *@var{data}, unsigned *@var{prologue_cost}, unsigned *@var{body_cost}, unsigned *@var{epilogue_cost})
5724 This hook should complete calculations of the cost of vectorizing a loop or basic block based on @var{data}, and return the prologue, body, and epilogue costs as unsigned integers. The default returns the value of the three accumulators.
5725 @end deftypefn
5726
5727 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_DESTROY_COST_DATA (void *@var{data})
5728 This hook should release @var{data} and any related data structures allocated by TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST. The default releases the accumulator.
5729 @end deftypefn
5730
5731 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_GATHER (const_tree @var{mem_vectype}, const_tree @var{index_type}, int @var{scale})
5732 Target builtin that implements vector gather operation. @var{mem_vectype}
5733 is the vector type of the load and @var{index_type} is scalar type of
5734 the index, scaled by @var{scale}.
5735 The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize gather
5736 loads.
5737 @end deftypefn
5738
5739 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_SCATTER (const_tree @var{vectype}, const_tree @var{index_type}, int @var{scale})
5740 Target builtin that implements vector scatter operation. @var{vectype}
5741 is the vector type of the store and @var{index_type} is scalar type of
5742 the index, scaled by @var{scale}.
5743 The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize scatter
5744 stores.
5745 @end deftypefn
5746
5747 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_COMPUTE_VECSIZE_AND_SIMDLEN (struct cgraph_node *@var{}, struct cgraph_simd_clone *@var{}, @var{tree}, @var{int})
5748 This hook should set @var{vecsize_mangle}, @var{vecsize_int}, @var{vecsize_float}
5749 fields in @var{simd_clone} structure pointed by @var{clone_info} argument and also
5750 @var{simdlen} field if it was previously 0.
5751 The hook should return 0 if SIMD clones shouldn't be emitted,
5752 or number of @var{vecsize_mangle} variants that should be emitted.
5753 @end deftypefn
5754
5755 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_ADJUST (struct cgraph_node *@var{})
5756 This hook should add implicit @code{attribute(target("..."))} attribute
5757 to SIMD clone @var{node} if needed.
5758 @end deftypefn
5759
5760 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_USABLE (struct cgraph_node *@var{})
5761 This hook should return -1 if SIMD clone @var{node} shouldn't be used
5762 in vectorized loops in current function, or non-negative number if it is
5763 usable. In that case, the smaller the number is, the more desirable it is
5764 to use it.
5765 @end deftypefn
5766
5767 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GOACC_VALIDATE_DIMS (tree @var{decl}, int *@var{dims}, int @var{fn_level})
5768 This hook should check the launch dimensions provided for an OpenACC
5769 compute region, or routine. Defaulted values are represented as -1
5770 and non-constant values as 0. The @var{fn_level} is negative for the
5771 function corresponding to the compute region. For a routine is is the
5772 outermost level at which partitioned execution may be spawned. It
5773 should fill in anything that needs to default to non-unity and verify
5774 non-defaults. Diagnostics should be issued as appropriate. Return
5775 true, if changes have been made. You must override this hook to
5776 provide dimensions larger than 1.
5777 @end deftypefn
5778
5779 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_GOACC_DIM_LIMIT (int @var{axis})
5780 This hook should return the maximum size of a particular dimension,
5781 or zero if unbounded.
5782 @end deftypefn
5783
5784 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GOACC_FORK_JOIN (gcall *@var{call}, const int *@var{dims}, bool @var{is_fork})
5785 This hook can be used to convert IFN_GOACC_FORK and IFN_GOACC_JOIN
5786 function calls to target-specific gimple, or indicate whether they
5787 should be retained. It is executed during the oacc_device_lower pass.
5788 It should return true, if the call should be retained. It should
5789 return false, if it is to be deleted (either because target-specific
5790 gimple has been inserted before it, or there is no need for it).
5791 The default hook returns false, if there are no RTL expanders for them.
5792 @end deftypefn
5793
5794 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_GOACC_REDUCTION (gcall *@var{call})
5795 This hook is used by the oacc_transform pass to expand calls to the
5796 @var{GOACC_REDUCTION} internal function, into a sequence of gimple
5797 instructions. @var{call} is gimple statement containing the call to
5798 the function. This hook removes statement @var{call} after the
5799 expanded sequence has been inserted. This hook is also responsible
5800 for allocating any storage for reductions when necessary.
5801 @end deftypefn
5802
5803 @node Anchored Addresses
5804 @section Anchored Addresses
5805 @cindex anchored addresses
5806 @cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
5807
5808 GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
5809 For example, if we have:
5810
5811 @smallexample
5812 static int a, b, c;
5813 int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
5814 @end smallexample
5815
5816 the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
5817 addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
5818 it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
5819 the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
5820 be something like:
5821
5822 @smallexample
5823 int foo (void)
5824 @{
5825 register int *xr = &x;
5826 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
5827 @}
5828 @end smallexample
5829
5830 (which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
5831 ``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
5832
5833 The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
5834 in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
5835 section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
5836 or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
5837
5838 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5839 The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
5840 On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
5841 applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
5842 for every mode. The default value is 0.
5843 @end deftypevr
5844
5845 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
5846 Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
5847 offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
5848 value is 0.
5849 @end deftypevr
5850
5851 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR (rtx @var{x})
5852 Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
5853 @code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
5854 The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
5855 of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
5856
5857 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
5858 it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
5859 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
5860 is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
5861 @end deftypefn
5862
5863 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P (const_rtx @var{x})
5864 Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
5865 @var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
5866 @samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
5867
5868 The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
5869 intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
5870 or target-specific sections.
5871 @end deftypefn
5872
5873 @node Condition Code
5874 @section Condition Code Status
5875 @cindex condition code status
5876
5877 The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
5878 two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
5879
5880 The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
5881 (@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
5882 clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
5883 register representation, which provides better schedulability for
5884 architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
5885 most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
5886 most RISC machines.
5887
5888 The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
5889 the definition and use of the condition code. In the past the definition
5890 and use were always adjacent. However, recent changes to support trapping
5891 arithmatic may result in the definition and user being in different blocks.
5892 Thus, there may be a @code{NOTE_INSN_BASIC_BLOCK} between them. Additionally,
5893 the definition may be the source of exception handling edges.
5894
5895 These restrictions can prevent important
5896 optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
5897 is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
5898 three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
5899 scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
5900 separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
5901
5902 For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
5903 represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
5904 condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
5905 condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
5906 or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
5907 Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
5908 that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
5909
5910 Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
5911 specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
5912 interested in most macros in this section.
5913
5914 @menu
5915 * CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
5916 * MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
5917 @end menu
5918
5919 @node CC0 Condition Codes
5920 @subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
5921 @findex cc0
5922
5923 @findex cc_status
5924 The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
5925 describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
5926 the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
5927 variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
5928 currently based, and several standard flags.
5929
5930 Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
5931 description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
5932 information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
5933
5934 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
5935 C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
5936 component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
5937
5938 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5939 @end defmac
5940
5941 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
5942 A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
5943 The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
5944 the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
5945 define this macro to initialize it.
5946
5947 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5948 @end defmac
5949
5950 @defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
5951 A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
5952 appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
5953 this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
5954 code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
5955 set @code{(cc0)}.
5956
5957 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
5958
5959 If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
5960 other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
5961 invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
5962 reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
5963 registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
5964 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
5965 insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
5966 based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
5967 value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
5968 this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
5969 @samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
5970 @code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
5971 condition code value.
5972
5973 The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
5974 with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
5975 @code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
5976 constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
5977 insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
5978 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
5979 @code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
5980
5981 A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
5982 that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
5983 @samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
5984 two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
5985 @end defmac
5986
5987 @node MODE_CC Condition Codes
5988 @subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
5989 @findex CCmode
5990 @findex MODE_CC
5991
5992 @defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
5993 On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
5994 than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
5995 code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
5996 when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
5997 bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
5998 branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
5999 this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
6000 record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
6001 also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g. a signed or an
6002 unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
6003
6004 If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
6005 @file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
6006 a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
6007 have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
6008 by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
6009 be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
6010 the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
6011
6012 @smallexample
6013 (define_insn ""
6014 [(set (reg:CC_NOOV 0)
6015 (compare:CC_NOOV
6016 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
6017 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
6018 (const_int 0)))]
6019 ""
6020 "@dots{}")
6021 @end smallexample
6022
6023 @noindent
6024 together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CC_NOOVmode}
6025 for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
6026
6027 @smallexample
6028 #define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
6029 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
6030 ? ((OP == LT || OP == LE || OP == GT || OP == GE) \
6031 ? CCFPEmode : CCFPmode) \
6032 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
6033 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG || GET_CODE (x) == ASHIFT) \
6034 ? CC_NOOVmode : CCmode))
6035 @end smallexample
6036
6037 Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
6038 were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
6039 this section.
6040
6041 You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
6042 in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
6043 @end defmac
6044
6045 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (int *@var{code}, rtx *@var{op0}, rtx *@var{op1}, bool @var{op0_preserve_value})
6046 On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
6047 convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
6048 does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
6049 comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
6050
6051 On such machines, implement this hook to do any required conversions.
6052 @var{code} is the initial comparison code and @var{op0} and @var{op1}
6053 are the left and right operands of the comparison, respectively. If
6054 @var{op0_preserve_value} is @code{true} the implementation is not
6055 allowed to change the value of @var{op0} since the value might be used
6056 in RTXs which aren't comparisons. E.g. the implementation is not
6057 allowed to swap operands in that case.
6058
6059 GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
6060 valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
6061 @file{md} file.
6062
6063 You need not to implement this hook if it would never change the
6064 comparison code or operands.
6065 @end deftypefn
6066
6067 @defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
6068 A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
6069 comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
6070 can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
6071 then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
6072
6073 You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
6074 floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
6075 For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
6076 inequality comparisons are given either @code{CCFPEmode} or @code{CCFPmode}:
6077
6078 @smallexample
6079 #define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) \
6080 ((MODE) != CCFPEmode && (MODE) != CCFPmode)
6081 @end smallexample
6082 @end defmac
6083
6084 @defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
6085 A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
6086 comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
6087 @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
6088 machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
6089 instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
6090 freely convert unordered compares to ordered ones. Then definition may look
6091 like:
6092
6093 @smallexample
6094 #define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
6095 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
6096 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
6097 @end smallexample
6098 @end defmac
6099
6100 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS (unsigned int *@var{p1}, unsigned int *@var{p2})
6101 On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
6102 register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
6103 regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
6104 hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
6105 small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
6106 to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
6107 arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
6108 When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
6109 integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
6110 @code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
6111
6112 The default version of this hook returns false.
6113 @end deftypefn
6114
6115 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE (machine_mode @var{m1}, machine_mode @var{m2})
6116 On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
6117 @code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
6118 validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
6119 target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
6120 both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
6121 return @code{VOIDmode}.
6122
6123 The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6124 same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
6125 returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6126 @end deftypefn
6127
6128 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FLAGS_REGNUM
6129 If the target has a dedicated flags register, and it needs to use the post-reload comparison elimination pass, then this value should be set appropriately.
6130 @end deftypevr
6131
6132 @node Costs
6133 @section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6134 @cindex costs of instructions
6135 @cindex relative costs
6136 @cindex speed of instructions
6137
6138 These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6139 on the target machine.
6140
6141 @defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
6142 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6143 register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6144 expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6145 value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6146 that.
6147
6148 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6149 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6150 registers if they are not general registers.
6151
6152 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6153 hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6154 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6155 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6156 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6157 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6158
6159 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6160 @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
6161 @end defmac
6162
6163 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST (machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{from}, reg_class_t @var{to})
6164 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6165 from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6166 are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6167 A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6168 that.
6169
6170 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6171 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6172 registers if they are not general registers.
6173
6174 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6175 hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6176 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6177 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6178 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6179 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6180
6181 The default version of this function returns 2.
6182 @end deftypefn
6183
6184 @defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
6185 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6186 register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
6187 is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
6188 is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6189 registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6190 should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6191
6192 If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6193 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6194 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6195 between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6196 more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6197 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6198
6199 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6200 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6201 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6202 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6203 4 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6204 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6205 are the same as to this macro.
6206
6207 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6208 @code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
6209 @end defmac
6210
6211 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST (machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{rclass}, bool @var{in})
6212 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6213 between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
6214 if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
6215 This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6216 If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6217 registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
6218
6219 If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6220 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6221 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6222 between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
6223 more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6224 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6225
6226 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6227 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6228 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6229 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6230 4 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6231 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6232 are the same as to this target hook.
6233 @end deftypefn
6234
6235 @defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
6236 A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is
6237 the default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter
6238 @var{speed_p} is true when the branch in question should be optimized
6239 for speed. When it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should return a value
6240 optimal for code size rather than performance. @var{predictable_p} is
6241 true for well-predicted branches. On many architectures the
6242 @code{BRANCH_COST} can be reduced then.
6243 @end defmac
6244
6245 Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
6246 but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
6247 ordinarily expect.
6248
6249 @defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
6250 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
6251 than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
6252 faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6253 require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6254 between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6255
6256 When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6257 finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6258 load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6259 faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6260 may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6261 other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
6262 @end defmac
6263
6264 @defmac SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (@var{mode}, @var{alignment})
6265 Define this macro to be the value 1 if memory accesses described by the
6266 @var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6267 than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap
6268 handler.
6269
6270 When this macro is nonzero, the compiler will act as if
6271 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were nonzero when generating code for block
6272 moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
6273 Therefore, do not set this macro nonzero if unaligned accesses only add a
6274 cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6275
6276 If the value of this macro is always zero, it need not be defined. If
6277 this macro is defined, it should produce a nonzero value when
6278 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is nonzero.
6279 @end defmac
6280
6281 @defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
6282 The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
6283 which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
6284 string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6285 make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6286
6287 Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6288 @code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6289 the number of such sequences.
6290
6291 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6292 optimized for speed rather than size.
6293
6294 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6295 @end defmac
6296
6297 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BY_PIECES_INFRASTRUCTURE_P (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size}, unsigned int @var{alignment}, enum by_pieces_operation @var{op}, bool @var{speed_p})
6298 GCC will attempt several strategies when asked to copy between
6299 two areas of memory, or to set, clear or store to memory, for example
6300 when copying a @code{struct}. The @code{by_pieces} infrastructure
6301 implements such memory operations as a sequence of load, store or move
6302 insns. Alternate strategies are to expand the
6303 @code{movmem} or @code{setmem} optabs, to emit a library call, or to emit
6304 unit-by-unit, loop-based operations.
6305
6306 This target hook should return true if, for a memory operation with a
6307 given @var{size} and @var{alignment}, using the @code{by_pieces}
6308 infrastructure is expected to result in better code generation.
6309 Both @var{size} and @var{alignment} are measured in terms of storage
6310 units.
6311
6312 The parameter @var{op} is one of: @code{CLEAR_BY_PIECES},
6313 @code{MOVE_BY_PIECES}, @code{SET_BY_PIECES}, @code{STORE_BY_PIECES}.
6314 These describe the type of memory operation under consideration.
6315
6316 The parameter @var{speed_p} is true if the code is currently being
6317 optimized for speed rather than size.
6318
6319 Returning true for higher values of @var{size} can improve code generation
6320 for speed if the target does not provide an implementation of the
6321 @code{movmem} or @code{setmem} standard names, if the @code{movmem} or
6322 @code{setmem} implementation would be more expensive than a sequence of
6323 insns, or if the overhead of a library call would dominate that of
6324 the body of the memory operation.
6325
6326 Returning true for higher values of @code{size} may also cause an increase
6327 in code size, for example where the number of insns emitted to perform a
6328 move would be greater than that of a library call.
6329 @end deftypefn
6330
6331 @defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
6332 A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6333 a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
6334 @end defmac
6335
6336 @defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
6337 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6338 of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6339 or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6340 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6341
6342 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6343 optimized for speed rather than size.
6344
6345 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6346 @end defmac
6347
6348 @defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
6349 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6350 of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
6351 a block set insn or a library call.
6352 Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6353 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6354
6355 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6356 optimized for speed rather than size.
6357
6358 If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6359 @end defmac
6360
6361 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6362 A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6363 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6364 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6365 @end defmac
6366
6367 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6368 A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6369 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6370 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6371 @end defmac
6372
6373 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6374 A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6375 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6376 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6377 @end defmac
6378
6379 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6380 A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6381 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6382 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6383 @end defmac
6384
6385 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6386 A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6387 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6388 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6389 @end defmac
6390
6391 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6392 A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6393 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6394 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6395 @end defmac
6396
6397 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6398 This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6399 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6400 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6401 @end defmac
6402
6403 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6404 This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6405 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6406 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6407 @end defmac
6408
6409 @defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
6410 Define this macro to be true if it is as good or better to call a constant
6411 function address than to call an address kept in a register.
6412 @end defmac
6413
6414 @defmac LOGICAL_OP_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6415 Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6416 @samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6417 @code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6418 @end defmac
6419
6420 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTAB_SUPPORTED_P (int @var{op}, machine_mode @var{mode1}, machine_mode @var{mode2}, optimization_type @var{opt_type})
6421 Return true if the optimizers should use optab @var{op} with
6422 modes @var{mode1} and @var{mode2} for optimization type @var{opt_type}.
6423 The optab is known to have an associated @file{.md} instruction
6424 whose C condition is true. @var{mode2} is only meaningful for conversion
6425 optabs; for direct optabs it is a copy of @var{mode1}.
6426
6427 For example, when called with @var{op} equal to @code{rint_optab} and
6428 @var{mode1} equal to @code{DFmode}, the hook should say whether the
6429 optimizers should use optab @code{rintdf2}.
6430
6431 The default hook returns true for all inputs.
6432 @end deftypefn
6433
6434 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RTX_COSTS (rtx @var{x}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{outer_code}, int @var{opno}, int *@var{total}, bool @var{speed})
6435 This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6436
6437 The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
6438 available for examination in @var{x}, and the fact that @var{x} appears
6439 as operand @var{opno} of an expression with rtx code @var{outer_code}.
6440 That is, the hook can assume that there is some rtx @var{y} such
6441 that @samp{GET_CODE (@var{y}) == @var{outer_code}} and such that
6442 either (a) @samp{XEXP (@var{y}, @var{opno}) == @var{x}} or
6443 (b) @samp{XVEC (@var{y}, @var{opno})} contains @var{x}.
6444
6445 @var{mode} is @var{x}'s machine mode, or for cases like @code{const_int} that
6446 do not have a mode, the mode in which @var{x} is used.
6447
6448 In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6449 @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6450 instructions.
6451
6452 On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6453 for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
6454 necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6455 for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6456 operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6457
6458 When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6459 false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6460 size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6461
6462 The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6463 processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6464 @end deftypefn
6465
6466 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDRESS_COST (rtx @var{address}, machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as}, bool @var{speed})
6467 This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6468 @var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6469 the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6470
6471 For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6472 true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6473 instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6474 all addresses will have equal costs.
6475
6476 In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6477 the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6478 cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6479
6480 For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6481 and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6482 is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6483 references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6484 the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6485 that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6486 instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6487 specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6488
6489 This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6490
6491 On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6492 cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6493 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6494 be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6495 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6496 should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6497 should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6498 registers on machines with lots of registers.
6499 @end deftypefn
6500
6501 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NO_SPECULATION_IN_DELAY_SLOTS_P (void)
6502 This predicate controls the use of the eager delay slot filler to disallow
6503 speculatively executed instructions being placed in delay slots. Targets
6504 such as certain MIPS architectures possess both branches with and without
6505 delay slots. As the eager delay slot filler can decrease performance,
6506 disabling it is beneficial when ordinary branches are available. Use of
6507 delay slot branches filled using the basic filler is often still desirable
6508 as the delay slot can hide a pipeline bubble.
6509 @end deftypefn
6510
6511 @node Scheduling
6512 @section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6513
6514 The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6515 adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6516 hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6517 them: try the first ones in this list first.
6518
6519 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE (void)
6520 This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6521 issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6522 Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6523 an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6524 constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6525 hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6526 This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
6527 it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
6528 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6529 @end deftypefn
6530
6531 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{more})
6532 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6533 from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
6534 still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
6535 @samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6536 @code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6537 You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6538 than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6539 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6540 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6541 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
6542 was scheduled.
6543 @end deftypefn
6544
6545 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, rtx @var{link}, rtx_insn *@var{dep_insn}, int @var{cost})
6546 This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6547 relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through the
6548 dependence @var{link}. It should return the new value. The default
6549 is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be used for example
6550 to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline description
6551 that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost as a
6552 data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6553 description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6554 output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6555 times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
6556 acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
6557 @pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
6558 @end deftypefn
6559
6560 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{priority})
6561 This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
6562 @var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
6563 execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
6564 later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6565 scheduling priorities of insns.
6566 @end deftypefn
6567
6568 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn **@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
6569 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6570 list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6571 combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6572 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6573 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6574 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6575 list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
6576 a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
6577 reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
6578 @var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
6579 is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
6580 the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
6581 can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
6582 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
6583 @end deftypefn
6584
6585 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2 (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn **@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
6586 Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
6587 function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
6588 is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
6589 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
6590 return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
6591 this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
6592 scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
6593 cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
6594 @end deftypefn
6595
6596 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_MACRO_FUSION_P (void)
6597 This hook is used to check whether target platform supports macro fusion.
6598 @end deftypefn
6599
6600 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_MACRO_FUSION_PAIR_P (rtx_insn *@var{prev}, rtx_insn *@var{curr})
6601 This hook is used to check whether two insns should be macro fused for
6602 a target microarchitecture. If this hook returns true for the given insn pair
6603 (@var{prev} and @var{curr}), the scheduler will put them into a sched
6604 group, and they will not be scheduled apart. The two insns will be either
6605 two SET insns or a compare and a conditional jump and this hook should
6606 validate any dependencies needed to fuse the two insns together.
6607 @end deftypefn
6608
6609 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK (rtx_insn *@var{head}, rtx_insn *@var{tail})
6610 This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
6611 chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
6612 correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
6613 example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
6614 analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
6615 dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
6616 calculated.
6617 @end deftypefn
6618
6619 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{max_ready})
6620 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
6621 instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
6622 pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
6623 is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6624 @var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
6625 region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
6626 scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
6627 @end deftypefn
6628
6629 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6630 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
6631 instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
6632 cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
6633 is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
6634 to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6635 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6636 @end deftypefn
6637
6638 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{old_max_uid})
6639 This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
6640 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6641 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6642 @var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
6643 @end deftypefn
6644
6645 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
6646 This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
6647 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
6648 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
6649 @end deftypefn
6650
6651 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6652 The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
6653 pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
6654 when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
6655 simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
6656 processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
6657 based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
6658 when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
6659 @end deftypefn
6660
6661 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6662 The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6663 @end deftypefn
6664
6665 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {rtx_insn *} TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6666 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6667 to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
6668 simulated processor cycle finishes.
6669 @end deftypefn
6670
6671 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
6672 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
6673 used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
6674 @end deftypefn
6675
6676 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
6677 The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
6678 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6679 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6680 state on a single insn is not enough.
6681 @end deftypefn
6682
6683 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
6684 The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
6685 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
6686 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
6687 state on a single insn is not enough.
6688 @end deftypefn
6689
6690 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD (void)
6691 This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
6692 for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
6693 chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
6694 value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
6695 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
6696 subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
6697 maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
6698 @acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
6699 packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
6700 rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
6701
6702 This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
6703 processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
6704 with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
6705 @var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
6706 @var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
6707 processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
6708 @var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
6709 until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
6710 the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
6711
6712 Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
6713 pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
6714 schedules to choose the best one.
6715
6716 The default is no multipass scheduling.
6717 @end deftypefn
6718
6719 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{ready_index})
6720
6721 This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
6722 considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
6723 zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be considered in multipass scheduling.
6724 Positive return values will remove @var{insn} from consideration on
6725 the current round of multipass scheduling.
6726 Negative return values will remove @var{insn} from consideration for given
6727 number of cycles.
6728 Backends should be careful about returning non-zero for highest priority
6729 instruction at position 0 in the ready list. @var{ready_index} is passed
6730 to allow backends make correct judgements.
6731
6732 The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
6733 @end deftypefn
6734
6735 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN (void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, bool @var{first_cycle_insn_p})
6736 This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass
6737 scheduling.
6738 @end deftypefn
6739
6740 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE (void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, const void *@var{prev_data})
6741 This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
6742 @end deftypefn
6743
6744 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK (const void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready})
6745 This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
6746 an instruction.
6747 @end deftypefn
6748
6749 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END (const void *@var{data})
6750 This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
6751 round of multipass scheduling.
6752 @end deftypefn
6753
6754 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT (void *@var{data})
6755 This hook initializes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6756 @end deftypefn
6757
6758 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI (void *@var{data})
6759 This hook finalizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
6760 @end deftypefn
6761
6762 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE (FILE *@var{dump}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{last_clock}, int @var{clock}, int *@var{sort_p})
6763 This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
6764 on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
6765 @var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
6766 the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
6767 is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
6768 start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
6769 verbosity level to use for debugging output.
6770 @var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
6771 processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
6772 and the current processor cycle.
6773 @end deftypefn
6774
6775 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE (struct _dep *@var{_dep}, int @var{cost}, int @var{distance})
6776 This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
6777 the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
6778 are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
6779 to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
6780 being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
6781 dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
6782 parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
6783 The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
6784 insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
6785 and @code{false} otherwise.
6786
6787 Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
6788 where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
6789 delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
6790 that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
6791 important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
6792 closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
6793 not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
6794 @end deftypefn
6795
6796 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED (void)
6797 This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
6798 the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
6799 per instruction data structures.
6800 @end deftypefn
6801
6802 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT (void)
6803 Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
6804 @end deftypefn
6805
6806 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc}, bool @var{clean_p})
6807 Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
6808 It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
6809 beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
6810 @end deftypefn
6811
6812 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6813 Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
6814 @end deftypefn
6815
6816 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6817 Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6818 @end deftypefn
6819
6820 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
6821 Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
6822 @end deftypefn
6823
6824 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, unsigned int @var{dep_status}, rtx *@var{new_pat})
6825 This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
6826 speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
6827 The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
6828 version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
6829 pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
6830 or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
6831 speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
6832 the generated speculative pattern.
6833 @end deftypefn
6834
6835 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P (unsigned int @var{dep_status})
6836 This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
6837 for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
6838 instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
6839 @end deftypefn
6840
6841 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, rtx_insn *@var{label}, unsigned int @var{ds})
6842 This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
6843 check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
6844 speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
6845 @var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
6846 be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
6847 recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
6848 a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
6849 @var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
6850 @end deftypefn
6851
6852 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS (struct spec_info_def *@var{spec_info})
6853 This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
6854 enabled/used.
6855 The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
6856 The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
6857 @end deftypefn
6858
6859 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII (struct ddg *@var{g})
6860 This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
6861 resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
6862 the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
6863 backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
6864 bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
6865 of instructions divided by the issue rate.
6866 @end deftypefn
6867
6868 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{x})
6869 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
6870 is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
6871 @end deftypefn
6872
6873 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{x})
6874 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
6875 in its second parameter.
6876 @end deftypefn
6877
6878 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_EXPOSED_PIPELINE
6879 True if the processor has an exposed pipeline, which means that not just
6880 the order of instructions is important for correctness when scheduling, but
6881 also the latencies of operations.
6882 @end deftypevr
6883
6884 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REASSOCIATION_WIDTH (unsigned int @var{opc}, machine_mode @var{mode})
6885 This hook is called by tree reassociator to determine a level of
6886 parallelism required in output calculations chain.
6887 @end deftypefn
6888
6889 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FUSION_PRIORITY (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{max_pri}, int *@var{fusion_pri}, int *@var{pri})
6890 This hook is called by scheduling fusion pass. It calculates fusion
6891 priorities for each instruction passed in by parameter. The priorities
6892 are returned via pointer parameters.
6893
6894 @var{insn} is the instruction whose priorities need to be calculated.
6895 @var{max_pri} is the maximum priority can be returned in any cases.
6896 @var{fusion_pri} is the pointer parameter through which @var{insn}'s
6897 fusion priority should be calculated and returned.
6898 @var{pri} is the pointer parameter through which @var{insn}'s priority
6899 should be calculated and returned.
6900
6901 Same @var{fusion_pri} should be returned for instructions which should
6902 be scheduled together. Different @var{pri} should be returned for
6903 instructions with same @var{fusion_pri}. @var{fusion_pri} is the major
6904 sort key, @var{pri} is the minor sort key. All instructions will be
6905 scheduled according to the two priorities. All priorities calculated
6906 should be between 0 (exclusive) and @var{max_pri} (inclusive). To avoid
6907 false dependencies, @var{fusion_pri} of instructions which need to be
6908 scheduled together should be smaller than @var{fusion_pri} of irrelevant
6909 instructions.
6910
6911 Given below example:
6912
6913 @smallexample
6914 ldr r10, [r1, 4]
6915 add r4, r4, r10
6916 ldr r15, [r2, 8]
6917 sub r5, r5, r15
6918 ldr r11, [r1, 0]
6919 add r4, r4, r11
6920 ldr r16, [r2, 12]
6921 sub r5, r5, r16
6922 @end smallexample
6923
6924 On targets like ARM/AArch64, the two pairs of consecutive loads should be
6925 merged. Since peephole2 pass can't help in this case unless consecutive
6926 loads are actually next to each other in instruction flow. That's where
6927 this scheduling fusion pass works. This hook calculates priority for each
6928 instruction based on its fustion type, like:
6929
6930 @smallexample
6931 ldr r10, [r1, 4] ; fusion_pri=99, pri=96
6932 add r4, r4, r10 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
6933 ldr r15, [r2, 8] ; fusion_pri=98, pri=92
6934 sub r5, r5, r15 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
6935 ldr r11, [r1, 0] ; fusion_pri=99, pri=100
6936 add r4, r4, r11 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
6937 ldr r16, [r2, 12] ; fusion_pri=98, pri=88
6938 sub r5, r5, r16 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
6939 @end smallexample
6940
6941 Scheduling fusion pass then sorts all ready to issue instructions according
6942 to the priorities. As a result, instructions of same fusion type will be
6943 pushed together in instruction flow, like:
6944
6945 @smallexample
6946 ldr r11, [r1, 0]
6947 ldr r10, [r1, 4]
6948 ldr r15, [r2, 8]
6949 ldr r16, [r2, 12]
6950 add r4, r4, r10
6951 sub r5, r5, r15
6952 add r4, r4, r11
6953 sub r5, r5, r16
6954 @end smallexample
6955
6956 Now peephole2 pass can simply merge the two pairs of loads.
6957
6958 Since scheduling fusion pass relies on peephole2 to do real fusion
6959 work, it is only enabled by default when peephole2 is in effect.
6960
6961 This is firstly introduced on ARM/AArch64 targets, please refer to
6962 the hook implementation for how different fusion types are supported.
6963 @end deftypefn
6964
6965 @node Sections
6966 @section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
6967 @c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
6968 @c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
6969
6970 An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
6971 data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
6972 section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
6973 section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
6974 section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
6975 of sections.
6976
6977 @file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
6978 @code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
6979 The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
6980 is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
6981 as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
6982 initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
6983 They may however depend on command-line flags.
6984
6985 @emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
6986 use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
6987 to be string literals.
6988
6989 Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
6990 section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
6991 should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
6992 @code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
6993
6994 You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
6995 @code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
6996 in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
6997 @code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
6998 create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
6999 reuse @code{text_section}.
7000
7001 All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
7002 if the target does not provide them.
7003
7004 @defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
7005 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
7006 assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
7007 Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
7008 @end defmac
7009
7010 @defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
7011 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
7012 frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
7013 a default definition if the target supports named sections.
7014 @end defmac
7015
7016 @defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
7017 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
7018 executed functions in the program.
7019 @end defmac
7020
7021 @defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
7022 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
7023 assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
7024 data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
7025 @end defmac
7026
7027 @defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
7028 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7029 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7030 initialized, writable small data.
7031 @end defmac
7032
7033 @defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
7034 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
7035 assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
7036 data.
7037 @end defmac
7038
7039 @defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
7040 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7041 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7042 uninitialized global data. If not defined, and
7043 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} not defined,
7044 uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
7045 @option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
7046 used.
7047 @end defmac
7048
7049 @defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
7050 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7051 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7052 uninitialized, writable small data.
7053 @end defmac
7054
7055 @defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
7056 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
7057 assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
7058 common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
7059 @end defmac
7060
7061 @defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
7062 If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
7063 containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
7064 default is @code{'T'}.
7065 @end defmac
7066
7067 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
7068 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7069 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7070 initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
7071 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
7072 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
7073 @end defmac
7074
7075 @defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
7076 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7077 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7078 finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
7079 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
7080 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
7081 @end defmac
7082
7083 @defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
7084 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7085 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7086 part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
7087 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
7088 both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
7089 @end defmac
7090
7091 @defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
7092 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7093 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7094 part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
7095 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
7096 both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
7097 @end defmac
7098
7099 @defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
7100 If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
7101 via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
7102 the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
7103 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
7104 to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
7105 sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
7106 ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
7107 registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
7108 constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
7109 @end defmac
7110
7111 @defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
7112 If defined, a string which names the section into which small
7113 variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
7114 when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
7115 you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
7116 they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
7117 expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
7118 MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
7119 require small data support from your application, but use this macro
7120 to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
7121 access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
7122 @end defmac
7123
7124 @defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
7125 If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
7126 arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
7127 @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
7128 and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
7129 @end defmac
7130
7131 @defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
7132 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
7133 tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
7134 section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
7135 readonly data section is used.
7136
7137 This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
7138 @end defmac
7139
7140 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS (void)
7141 Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
7142 @file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
7143 of its own that you need to create.
7144
7145 GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
7146 any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
7147 described below.
7148 @end deftypefn
7149
7150 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK (void)
7151 Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
7152 selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
7153 should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
7154 local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
7155
7156 The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
7157 is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
7158 when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
7159 in read-only sections even in executables.
7160 @end deftypefn
7161
7162 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION (tree @var{exp}, int @var{reloc}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7163 Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
7164 assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
7165 some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
7166 requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
7167 local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
7168 @var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
7169
7170 The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
7171 variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7172
7173 See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
7174 @end deftypefn
7175
7176 @defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
7177 Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
7178 for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
7179
7180 In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
7181 function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
7182 it is unlikely to be called.
7183 @end defmac
7184
7185 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, int @var{reloc})
7186 Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
7187 and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7188 As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
7189 the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
7190
7191 The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
7192 ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
7193 example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
7194 Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
7195 @end deftypefn
7196
7197 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION (tree @var{decl})
7198 Return the readonly data section associated with
7199 @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7200 The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
7201 the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
7202 if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
7203 otherwise.
7204 @end deftypefn
7205
7206 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_MERGEABLE_RODATA_PREFIX
7207 Usually, the compiler uses the prefix @code{".rodata"} to construct
7208 section names for mergeable constant data. Define this macro to override
7209 the string if a different section name should be used.
7210 @end deftypevr
7211
7212 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_TM_CLONE_TABLE_SECTION (void)
7213 Return the section that should be used for transactional memory clone tables.
7214 @end deftypefn
7215
7216 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7217 Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
7218 should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
7219 constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
7220 case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
7221 in bits.
7222
7223 The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
7224 constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
7225 else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7226 @end deftypefn
7227
7228 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{id})
7229 Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
7230 by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
7231 the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
7232 or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
7233 hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
7234 your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
7235 returns the @var{id} provided.
7236 @end deftypefn
7237
7238 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO (tree @var{decl}, rtx @var{rtl}, int @var{new_decl_p})
7239 Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7240 treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7241 function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7242
7243 The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7244 @var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7245 an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7246 rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
7247 in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
7248
7249 In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7250 a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7251 will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7252 register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7253 rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7254 leave it alone.)
7255
7256 The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
7257 that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
7258 be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7259 declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7260 declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
7261 @var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
7262
7263 @cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7264 The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7265 @code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7266 Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7267 encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7268 discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7269
7270 The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7271 in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7272 @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7273 before overriding it.
7274 @end deftypefn
7275
7276 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING (const char *@var{name})
7277 Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7278 the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7279 may have added.
7280 @end deftypefn
7281
7282 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7283 Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7284 The default version of this hook always returns false.
7285 @end deftypefn
7286
7287 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
7288 Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7289 ``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
7290 @end deftypevr
7291
7292 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE (void)
7293 It returns true if target wants profile code emitted before prologue.
7294
7295 The default version of this hook use the target macro
7296 @code{PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE}.
7297 @end deftypefn
7298
7299 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7300 Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7301 rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7302 or executable image).
7303
7304 The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7305 for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7306 currently supported object file formats.
7307 @end deftypefn
7308
7309 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_TLS
7310 Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7311 The default value is false.
7312 @end deftypevr
7313
7314
7315 @node PIC
7316 @section Position Independent Code
7317 @cindex position independent code
7318 @cindex PIC
7319
7320 This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7321 independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
7322 generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7323 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7324 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7325 must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7326 when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7327 need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7328 relative addresses.
7329 @c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
7330 @c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7331
7332 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
7333 The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7334 data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
7335 processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
7336 is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7337 pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7338 is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
7339 necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
7340 when @code{flag_pic} is true).
7341 @end defmac
7342
7343 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
7344 A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7345 @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7346 the default is zero. Do not define
7347 this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
7348 @end defmac
7349
7350 @defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
7351 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7352 operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7353 You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7354 check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7355 check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7356 (including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7357 position independent code.
7358 @end defmac
7359
7360 @node Assembler Format
7361 @section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7362
7363 This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
7364 to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
7365 instructions do.
7366
7367 @menu
7368 * File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7369 * Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7370 * Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7371 * Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7372 * Initialization:: General principles of initialization
7373 and termination routines.
7374 * Macros for Initialization::
7375 Specific macros that control the handling of
7376 initialization and termination routines.
7377 * Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7378 * Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7379 * Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7380 * Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7381 @end menu
7382
7383 @node File Framework
7384 @subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7385 @cindex assembler format
7386 @cindex output of assembler code
7387
7388 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7389 This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7390
7391 @findex default_file_start
7392 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_START (void)
7393 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7394 find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7395 by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7396 quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7397 @code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7398 lets other target files rely on these variables.
7399 @end deftypefn
7400
7401 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7402 If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7403 printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7404 @option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7405 to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7406 definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7407 assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7408 whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7409
7410 The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7411 verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7412 comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7413 @end deftypevr
7414
7415 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7416 If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7417 for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7418 @code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7419 this to be done. The default is false.
7420 @end deftypevr
7421
7422 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_END (void)
7423 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7424 to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7425 @end deftypefn
7426
7427 @deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7428 Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7429 special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7430 the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7431 should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7432 need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7433 this function.
7434 @end deftypefun
7435
7436 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_START (void)
7437 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7438 to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7439 nothing.
7440 @end deftypefn
7441
7442 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_END (void)
7443 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7444 to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7445 nothing.
7446 @end deftypefn
7447
7448 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CODE_END (void)
7449 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7450 unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7451 here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7452 because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7453 nothing.
7454 @end deftypefn
7455
7456 @defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
7457 A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7458 assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7459 the end of the line.
7460 @end defmac
7461
7462 @defmac ASM_APP_ON
7463 A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7464 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7465 @code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7466 assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7467 that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
7468 @end defmac
7469
7470 @defmac ASM_APP_OFF
7471 A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7472 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7473 @code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7474 time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
7475 @end defmac
7476
7477 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7478 A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7479 which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7480 the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7481
7482 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7483 for the file format in use is appropriate.
7484 @end defmac
7485
7486 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name})
7487 Output COFF information or DWARF debugging information which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to the stdio stream @var{file}.
7488
7489 This target hook need not be defined if the standard form of output for the file format in use is appropriate.
7490 @end deftypefn
7491
7492 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (const char *@var{name})
7493 Output a string based on @var{name}, suitable for the @samp{#ident} directive, or the equivalent directive or pragma in non-C-family languages. If this hook is not defined, nothing is output for the @samp{#ident} directive.
7494 @end deftypefn
7495
7496 @defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7497 A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7498 @var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
7499 in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
7500 the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7501 of the filename using this macro.
7502 @end defmac
7503
7504 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION (const char *@var{name}, unsigned int @var{flags}, tree @var{decl})
7505 Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
7506 should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
7507 of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
7508 is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7509 this section is associated.
7510 @end deftypefn
7511
7512 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, enum node_frequency @var{freq}, bool @var{startup}, bool @var{exit})
7513 Return preferred text (sub)section for function @var{decl}.
7514 Main purpose of this function is to separate cold, normal and hot
7515 functions. @var{startup} is true when function is known to be used only
7516 at startup (from static constructors or it is @code{main()}).
7517 @var{exit} is true when function is known to be used only at exit
7518 (from static destructors).
7519 Return NULL if function should go to default text section.
7520 @end deftypefn
7521
7522 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SWITCHED_TEXT_SECTIONS (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{decl}, bool @var{new_is_cold})
7523 Used by the target to emit any assembler directives or additional labels needed when a function is partitioned between different sections. Output should be written to @var{file}. The function decl is available as @var{decl} and the new section is `cold' if @var{new_is_cold} is @code{true}.
7524 @end deftypefn
7525
7526 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7527 This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
7528 It must not be modified by command-line option processing.
7529 @end deftypevr
7530
7531 @anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
7532 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
7533 This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7534 section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7535 This is true on most ELF targets.
7536 @end deftypevr
7537
7538 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{name}, int @var{reloc})
7539 Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
7540 based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
7541 declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
7542 null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
7543
7544 The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
7545 read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
7546 need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
7547 set via @code{__attribute__}.
7548 @end deftypefn
7549
7550 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES (print_switch_type @var{type}, const char *@var{text})
7551 Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
7552 switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
7553 enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
7554 It can take the following values:
7555
7556 @table @gcctabopt
7557 @item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
7558 @var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
7559
7560 @item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
7561 @var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
7562 direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
7563 default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
7564 command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
7565 various different individual optimization passes.
7566
7567 @item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
7568 @var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
7569 ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
7570 target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
7571 time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
7572 warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
7573 wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
7574 necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
7575 perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
7576 switches.
7577
7578 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
7579 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7580
7581 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
7582 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
7583 @end table
7584
7585 The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
7586 supported in the future.
7587
7588 By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
7589 provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
7590 it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
7591 section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
7592 provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
7593 hook.
7594 @end deftypefn
7595
7596 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
7597 This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
7598 ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
7599 hook.
7600 @end deftypevr
7601
7602 @need 2000
7603 @node Data Output
7604 @subsection Output of Data
7605
7606
7607 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
7608 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
7609 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
7610 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
7611 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
7612 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
7613 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
7614 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
7615 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
7616 These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
7617 of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
7618 byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
7619 aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
7620 @code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
7621
7622 The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
7623 followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
7624 the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
7625 @end deftypevr
7626
7627 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_INTEGER (rtx @var{x}, unsigned int @var{size}, int @var{aligned_p})
7628 The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
7629 integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
7630 in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
7631 function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
7632 object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
7633 split the object into smaller parts.
7634
7635 The default implementation of this hook will use the
7636 @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
7637 when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
7638 @end deftypefn
7639
7640 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECL_END (void)
7641 Define this hook if the target assembler requires a special marker to
7642 terminate an initialized variable declaration.
7643 @end deftypefn
7644
7645 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (FILE *@var{file}, rtx @var{x})
7646 A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
7647 can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
7648 the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
7649 @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
7650
7651 If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
7652 so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
7653 itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
7654 return @code{true}.
7655 @end deftypefn
7656
7657 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
7658 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
7659 instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
7660 bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
7661 @code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
7662
7663 If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
7664 Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
7665 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
7666 @end defmac
7667
7668 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
7669 A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
7670 @var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
7671 is defined, and is otherwise unused.
7672 @end defmac
7673
7674 @defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
7675 You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
7676 expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
7677 pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
7678 GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
7679 not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
7680 pool before the function.
7681 @end defmac
7682
7683 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
7684 A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
7685 constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
7686 the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
7687 be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
7688 is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
7689 immediately after this call.
7690
7691 If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
7692 not be defined.
7693 @end defmac
7694
7695 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
7696 A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
7697 constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
7698 anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
7699
7700 The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
7701 assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
7702 output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
7703 @samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
7704 @var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
7705 alignment.
7706
7707 The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
7708 the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
7709 responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
7710 Here is how to do this:
7711
7712 @smallexample
7713 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
7714 @end smallexample
7715
7716 When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
7717 @code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
7718 entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
7719
7720 You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
7721 @end defmac
7722
7723 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
7724 A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
7725 pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
7726 function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
7727 obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
7728 constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
7729
7730 If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
7731 define this macro.
7732 @end defmac
7733
7734 @defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
7735 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
7736 used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
7737 to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
7738 a line separator uses multiple characters.
7739
7740 If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
7741 the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
7742 @end defmac
7743
7744 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
7745 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_CLOSE_PAREN
7746 These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
7747 assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
7748 default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
7749 @end deftypevr
7750
7751 These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
7752 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
7753
7754 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7755 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7756 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
7757 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7758 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7759 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
7760 These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
7761 target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
7762 the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
7763 @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
7764 simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
7765 @code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
7766 by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
7767 it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
7768 32 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
7769 on the host machine.
7770
7771 The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
7772 using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
7773 machine's memory.
7774 @end defmac
7775
7776 @node Uninitialized Data
7777 @subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
7778
7779 Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
7780 outputting a single uninitialized variable.
7781
7782 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7783 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7784 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
7785 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7786 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
7787 possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
7788 other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
7789 backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
7790 byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
7791 equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
7792 the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
7793 an ordinary undefined external.
7794
7795 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7796 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7797 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7798
7799 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7800 common global variables are output.
7801 @end defmac
7802
7803 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7804 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
7805 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7806 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
7807 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7808 as the number of bits.
7809 @end defmac
7810
7811 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7812 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
7813 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7814 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7815 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
7816 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
7817 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7818 @end defmac
7819
7820 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7821 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7822 @var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
7823 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{alignment}
7824 is the alignment specified as the number of bits.
7825
7826 Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
7827 @file{varasm.c} when defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
7828 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
7829 before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
7830 the name, and a newline.
7831
7832 There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define this macro.
7833 The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
7834 switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
7835 You do not need to do both.
7836
7837 Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
7838 non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
7839 efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
7840 not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
7841 common in order to save space in the object file.
7842 @end defmac
7843
7844 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
7845 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7846 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
7847 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
7848 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
7849
7850 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7851 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7852 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
7853
7854 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
7855 static variables are output.
7856 @end defmac
7857
7858 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7859 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
7860 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
7861 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
7862 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
7863 as the number of bits.
7864 @end defmac
7865
7866 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
7867 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
7868 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
7869 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
7870 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
7871 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
7872 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
7873 @end defmac
7874
7875 @node Label Output
7876 @subsection Output and Generation of Labels
7877
7878 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7879 This is about outputting labels.
7880
7881 @findex assemble_name
7882 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7883 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7884 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
7885 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7886 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7887 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7888 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7889 @end defmac
7890
7891 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7892 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7893 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
7894 a function.
7895 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
7896 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
7897 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
7898 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
7899
7900 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
7901 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
7902 @end defmac
7903
7904 @findex assemble_name_raw
7905 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7906 Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
7907 to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
7908 @code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
7909 that it is more efficient.
7910 @end defmac
7911
7912 @defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
7913 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7914 size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7915 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
7916 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7917
7918 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
7919 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
7920 for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
7921 macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
7922 define this macro.
7923 @end defmac
7924
7925 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
7926 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7927 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
7928 symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
7929 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7930 provided.
7931 @end defmac
7932
7933 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7934 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7935 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
7936 the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
7937 address.
7938
7939 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
7940 provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
7941 @samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
7942 the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
7943 not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
7944 to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
7945 @end defmac
7946
7947 @defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
7948 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
7949 @samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
7950 G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
7951 @samp{.} is used instead.
7952 @end defmac
7953
7954 @defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
7955 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
7956 @samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
7957 have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
7958 are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
7959 @end defmac
7960
7961 @defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
7962 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
7963 type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
7964 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
7965 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
7966
7967 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7968 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7969 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7970 types at all, do not define this macro.
7971 @end defmac
7972
7973 @defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
7974 A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
7975 the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
7976 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
7977 the default is not to define this macro.
7978
7979 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
7980 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
7981 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
7982 types at all, do not define this macro.
7983 @end defmac
7984
7985 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
7986 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7987 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
7988 symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
7989 that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
7990 you should not count on this.
7991
7992 If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
7993 definition of this macro is provided.
7994 @end defmac
7995
7996 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
7997 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
7998 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
7999 function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
8000 outputting the label definition (perhaps using
8001 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
8002 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
8003
8004 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
8005 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
8006
8007 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
8008 of this macro.
8009 @end defmac
8010
8011 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8012 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8013 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
8014 which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
8015 function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
8016 representing the function.
8017
8018 If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
8019
8020 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
8021 of this macro.
8022 @end defmac
8023
8024 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_COLD_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8025 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8026 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
8027 cold function partition which is being defined. This macro is responsible
8028 for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
8029 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
8030 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
8031
8032 If this macro is not defined, then the cold partition name is defined in the
8033 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
8034
8035 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
8036 of this macro.
8037 @end defmac
8038
8039 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_COLD_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8040 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8041 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a cold function
8042 partition which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
8043 cold partition of the function. The argument @var{decl} is the
8044 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
8045
8046 If this macro is not defined, then the partition size is not defined.
8047
8048 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
8049 of this macro.
8050 @end defmac
8051
8052 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8053 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8054 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
8055 initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
8056 label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
8057 @var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
8058
8059 If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
8060 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
8061
8062 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
8063 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
8064 @end defmac
8065
8066 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{expr}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
8067 A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
8068 for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
8069 target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
8070 @code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
8071 and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
8072 will be an internal label.
8073
8074 The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
8075 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
8076
8077 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
8078 @end deftypefn
8079
8080 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
8081 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8082 @var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
8083 for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
8084
8085 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
8086 nothing.
8087 @end defmac
8088
8089 @defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
8090 A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
8091 once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
8092 chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
8093 initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
8094 something about the size of the object.
8095
8096 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
8097 nothing.
8098
8099 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
8100 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
8101 @end defmac
8102
8103 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name})
8104 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
8105 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
8106 that is, available for reference from other files.
8107
8108 The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
8109 @code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
8110 @end deftypefn
8111
8112 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl})
8113 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
8114 @var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
8115 global; that is, available for reference from other files.
8116
8117 The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
8118 @end deftypefn
8119
8120 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_UNDEFINED_DECL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{decl})
8121 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
8122 @var{stream} some commands that will declare the name associated with
8123 @var{decl} which is not defined in the current translation unit. Most
8124 assemblers do not require anything to be output in this case.
8125 @end deftypefn
8126
8127 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8128 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8129 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
8130 that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
8131 no other definition is available. Use the expression
8132 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
8133 itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
8134 for making that name weak, and a newline.
8135
8136 If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
8137 support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
8138 macro.
8139 @end defmac
8140
8141 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8142 Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
8143 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
8144 or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
8145 should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
8146 defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8147 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
8148 to make @var{name} weak.
8149 @end defmac
8150
8151 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8152 Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
8153 symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
8154 declaration of @code{name}.
8155 @end defmac
8156
8157 @defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
8158 A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
8159 supports weak symbols.
8160
8161 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
8162 definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
8163 is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
8164 @end defmac
8165
8166 @defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
8167 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
8168
8169 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
8170 definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
8171 this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
8172 flag such as @option{-melf}.
8173 @end defmac
8174
8175 @defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
8176 A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
8177 public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
8178 be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
8179 format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
8180 section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
8181 requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
8182 @end defmac
8183
8184 @defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
8185 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
8186 semantics.
8187
8188 If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
8189 definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
8190 definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
8191 you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
8192 setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
8193 be emitted as one-only.
8194 @end defmac
8195
8196 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl}, int @var{visibility})
8197 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
8198 commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
8199 hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
8200 @end deftypefn
8201
8202 @defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
8203 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
8204 that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
8205 The default is @code{0}.
8206
8207 Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
8208 if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
8209 will have undefined references from other translation units, that
8210 symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
8211 thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
8212 (explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
8213 with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
8214
8215 The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
8216 targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
8217 restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
8218 table of contents.
8219 @end defmac
8220
8221 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
8222 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8223 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
8224 symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
8225 not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
8226 declaration.
8227
8228 This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
8229 The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
8230 @end defmac
8231
8232 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL (rtx @var{symref})
8233 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8234 pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
8235 library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
8236 @end deftypefn
8237
8238 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED (const char *@var{symbol})
8239 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8240 directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
8241 .no_dead_code_strip directive.
8242 @end deftypefn
8243
8244 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8245 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8246 @var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
8247 @var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
8248 is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
8249 systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
8250 @end defmac
8251
8252 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_ASSEMBLER_NAME (const char *@var{name})
8253 Given a symbol @var{name}, perform same mangling as @code{varasm.c}'s @code{assemble_name}, but in memory rather than to a file stream, returning result as an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE}. Required for correct LTO symtabs. The default implementation calls the @code{TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING} hook and then prepends the @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX}, if any.
8254 @end deftypefn
8255
8256 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
8257 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
8258 @code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
8259 will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
8260 to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
8261 encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
8262 @end defmac
8263
8264 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
8265 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
8266 result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
8267 @code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
8268 This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
8269 specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
8270 when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
8271 being taken.
8272 @end defmac
8273
8274 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{prefix}, unsigned long @var{labelno})
8275 A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
8276 name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
8277
8278 It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
8279 used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
8280 will have name conflicts with internal labels.
8281
8282 It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
8283 object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
8284 should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
8285 beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
8286 convention your system uses, and follow it.
8287
8288 The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
8289 @end deftypefn
8290
8291 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8292 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8293 label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8294 @var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8295 may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
8296 systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8297 bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8298 bundles.
8299
8300 If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8301 used.
8302 @end defmac
8303
8304 @defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8305 A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8306 is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8307
8308 This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
8309 produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
8310 with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8311
8312 If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8313 output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8314 @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8315 string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8316 to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8317 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8318 you should know what it does on your machine.)
8319 @end defmac
8320
8321 @defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
8322 A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8323 @code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8324 @var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8325 added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8326
8327 The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8328 produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8329 @var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8330 assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8331 macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8332 internal static variables in different scopes.
8333
8334 Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8335 conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8336 or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8337 between the name and the number will suffice.
8338
8339 If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8340 which is correct for most systems.
8341 @end defmac
8342
8343 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8344 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8345 which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8346
8347 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8348 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8349 correct for most systems.
8350 @end defmac
8351
8352 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8353 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8354 which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
8355 to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8356 be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8357 the tree nodes are available.
8358
8359 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8360 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8361 correct for most systems.
8362 @end defmac
8363
8364 @defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8365 A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8366 (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8367 of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8368 current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8369 This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8370 @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8371 @end defmac
8372
8373 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8374 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8375 which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8376 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8377 an undefined weak symbol.
8378
8379 Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
8380 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
8381 @end defmac
8382
8383 @defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
8384 Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
8385 Objective-C methods.
8386
8387 The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8388 class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8389 the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8390 @samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8391
8392 These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8393 the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8394 systems define other ways of computing names.
8395
8396 @var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8397 buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8398 @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
8399 50 characters extra.
8400
8401 The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8402 method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
8403 @var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
8404 in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8405
8406 On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8407 macro to provide more human-readable names.
8408 @end defmac
8409
8410 @node Initialization
8411 @subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8412 @cindex initialization routines
8413 @cindex termination routines
8414 @cindex constructors, output of
8415 @cindex destructors, output of
8416
8417 The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8418 (also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8419 data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8420 to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8421 @code{main} is called.
8422
8423 Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8424 @dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8425 terminates.
8426
8427 To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8428 must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8429 be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8430 system, you need to specify how to do this.
8431
8432 There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8433 initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8434 Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8435
8436 @findex __CTOR_LIST__
8437 @findex __DTOR_LIST__
8438 The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8439 initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8440 termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8441
8442 Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
8443 0, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8444 the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8445 pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8446 pointer containing zero.
8447
8448 Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8449 @file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8450 time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8451 list; destructors in forward order.
8452
8453 The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8454 formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8455 aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8456 Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8457 object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8458 the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8459 accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8460 Termination functions are handled similarly.
8461
8462 This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8463 @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
8464 support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
8465 constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8466 and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
8467
8468 When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8469 upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
8470 support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
8471 parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
8472 program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
8473
8474 @smallexample
8475 ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
8476 @end smallexample
8477
8478 The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8479 section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
8480 for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
8481 files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8482 are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8483
8484 The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8485 compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
8486 fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8487 to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
8488 of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8489 that invokes the routines we need at startup.
8490
8491 To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8492 macro properly.
8493
8494 If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8495 @code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8496 entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8497 it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8498 after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
8499 in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
8500
8501 In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8502 two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8503 and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
8504 @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
8505 entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8506 and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8507 code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
8508 the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
8509 placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8510 a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
8511 @code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
8512 section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8513 the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8514 the initialization process.
8515
8516 The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8517 This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
8518 file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
8519 this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8520 termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
8521 an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
8522 pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8523 the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8524 initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
8525 via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
8526 @code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
8527
8528 @ifinfo
8529 The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8530 customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8531 @end ifinfo
8532
8533 @node Macros for Initialization
8534 @subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
8535
8536 Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
8537 and termination functions:
8538
8539 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
8540 If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
8541 operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
8542 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
8543 using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
8544 macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
8545 run the initialization functions.
8546 @end defmac
8547
8548 @defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
8549 If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
8550 This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
8551 on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
8552 be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
8553 @end defmac
8554
8555 @defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
8556 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8557 the following symbol is an initialization routine.
8558 @end defmac
8559
8560 @defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
8561 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
8562 the following symbol is a finalization routine.
8563 @end defmac
8564
8565 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8566 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8567 automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
8568 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8569 the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
8570 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
8571
8572 This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
8573 shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
8574 exception tables embedded in the code.
8575 @end defmac
8576
8577 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
8578 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
8579 automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
8580 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
8581 the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
8582 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
8583 @end defmac
8584
8585 @defmac INVOKE__main
8586 If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
8587 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
8588 where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
8589 useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
8590 @end defmac
8591
8592 @defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
8593 If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
8594 compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
8595 of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
8596 encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
8597 @end defmac
8598
8599 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
8600 This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
8601 collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
8602 It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
8603 @end deftypevr
8604
8605 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8606 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
8607 the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
8608
8609 Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
8610 no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
8611 priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
8612 otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
8613
8614 If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
8615 be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
8616 target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
8617 is not defined.
8618 @end deftypefn
8619
8620 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
8621 This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
8622 functions rather than initialization functions.
8623 @end deftypefn
8624
8625 If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
8626 generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
8627
8628 If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
8629 constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
8630 an object file for constructor functions to be called.
8631
8632 On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
8633 @command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
8634
8635 @defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
8636 Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
8637 object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
8638 object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
8639
8640 This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
8641 part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
8642 @end defmac
8643
8644 @defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
8645 Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
8646 to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
8647 @command{nm}.
8648 @end defmac
8649
8650 @defmac NM_FLAGS
8651 @command{collect2} calls @command{nm} to scan object files for static
8652 constructors and destructors and LTO info. By default, @option{-n} is
8653 passed. Define @code{NM_FLAGS} to a C string constant if other options
8654 are needed to get the same output format as GNU @command{nm -n}
8655 produces.
8656 @end defmac
8657
8658 If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
8659 dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
8660 these macros to enable support for running initialization and
8661 termination functions in shared libraries:
8662
8663 @defmac LDD_SUFFIX
8664 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
8665 which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{ldd} under SunOS 4.
8666 @end defmac
8667
8668 @defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
8669 Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
8670 of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
8671 of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
8672 from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
8673 code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
8674 line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
8675 @end defmac
8676
8677 @defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
8678 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
8679 library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
8680 strips version information after this suffix when generating global
8681 constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
8682 that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
8683 @end defmac
8684
8685 @node Instruction Output
8686 @subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
8687
8688 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8689 This describes assembler instruction output.
8690
8691 @defmac REGISTER_NAMES
8692 A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
8693 registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
8694 register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
8695 @end defmac
8696
8697 @defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
8698 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
8699 and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
8700 registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
8701 to registers using alternate names.
8702 @end defmac
8703
8704 @defmac OVERLAPPING_REGISTER_NAMES
8705 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a
8706 name, a register number and a count of the number of consecutive
8707 machine registers the name overlaps. This macro defines additional
8708 names for hard registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in
8709 declarations to refer to registers using alternate names. Unlike
8710 @code{ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES}, this macro should be used when the
8711 register name implies multiple underlying registers.
8712
8713 This macro should be used when it is important that a clobber in an
8714 @code{asm} statement clobbers all the underlying values implied by the
8715 register name. For example, on ARM, clobbering the double-precision
8716 VFP register ``d0'' implies clobbering both single-precision registers
8717 ``s0'' and ``s1''.
8718 @end defmac
8719
8720 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
8721 Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
8722 requires different names for the machine instructions.
8723
8724 The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
8725 assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
8726 macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
8727 points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
8728 written in the machine description. The definition should output the
8729 opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
8730 increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
8731 so that it will not be output twice.
8732
8733 In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
8734 name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
8735 that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
8736 care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
8737 @var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
8738
8739 @findex recog_data.operand
8740 If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
8741 elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
8742
8743 If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
8744 in the usual way.
8745 @end defmac
8746
8747 @defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
8748 If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
8749 assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
8750 they will be output differently.
8751
8752 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8753 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8754 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8755 The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
8756 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
8757 by changing the contents of the vector.
8758
8759 This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
8760 file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
8761 can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
8762 as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
8763 syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
8764 writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
8765
8766 If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
8767 @end defmac
8768
8769 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN (FILE *@var{file}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, rtx *@var{opvec}, int @var{noperands})
8770 If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
8771 output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
8772 if necessary.
8773
8774 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
8775 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
8776 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
8777 The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
8778 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
8779 by checking the contents of the vector.
8780 @end deftypefn
8781
8782 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
8783 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8784 assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
8785 RTL expression.
8786
8787 @var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
8788 of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
8789 printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
8790 the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
8791 operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
8792 @var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
8793 @var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
8794
8795 @findex reg_names
8796 If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
8797 The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
8798 @code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
8799 @code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
8800
8801 When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
8802 (a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
8803 with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
8804 @var{code}.
8805 @end defmac
8806
8807 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
8808 A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
8809 punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
8810 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
8811 punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
8812 in this way.
8813 @end defmac
8814
8815 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
8816 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
8817 assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
8818 whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
8819
8820 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
8821 On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
8822 section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
8823 @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
8824 @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
8825 Format}.
8826 @end defmac
8827
8828 @findex dbr_sequence_length
8829 @defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
8830 A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
8831 been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
8832 determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
8833 currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
8834 or whatever.
8835
8836 Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
8837 reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
8838 explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
8839 @end defmac
8840
8841 @findex final_sequence
8842 Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
8843 prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
8844 (i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
8845 found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
8846 processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
8847 being output.
8848
8849 @findex asm_fprintf
8850 @defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
8851 @defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
8852 @defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
8853 @defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
8854 If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
8855 @samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
8856 @file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
8857 support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
8858 files can define these macros differently.
8859 @end defmac
8860
8861 @defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
8862 If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
8863 statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
8864 the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
8865 printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
8866 statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
8867 generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
8868 specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
8869 The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
8870 string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
8871 upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
8872 @end defmac
8873
8874 @defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
8875 If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
8876 different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
8877 numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
8878 first variant.
8879
8880 If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
8881 @smallexample
8882 @samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
8883 @end smallexample
8884 @noindent
8885 in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
8886 first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
8887 @samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
8888 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
8889 within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
8890 alternatives within the braces than the value of
8891 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing. If it's needed
8892 to print curly braces or @samp{|} character in assembler output directly,
8893 @samp{%@{}, @samp{%@}} and @samp{%|} can be used.
8894
8895 If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
8896 @samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
8897 operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
8898
8899 Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
8900 @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
8901 the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
8902 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
8903 if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
8904 opcodes or operand order.
8905 @end defmac
8906
8907 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8908 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8909 which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
8910 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8911 profiling.
8912 @end defmac
8913
8914 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
8915 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
8916 which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
8917 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
8918 profiling.
8919 @end defmac
8920
8921 @node Dispatch Tables
8922 @subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
8923
8924 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8925 This concerns dispatch tables.
8926
8927 @cindex dispatch table
8928 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
8929 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8930 pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
8931 @var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
8932 definitions of these labels are output using
8933 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
8934 way here. For example,
8935
8936 @smallexample
8937 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
8938 @var{value}, @var{rel})
8939 @end smallexample
8940
8941 You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
8942 dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
8943 will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
8944 @var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
8945 mode and flags can be read.
8946 @end defmac
8947
8948 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
8949 This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
8950 in a dispatch table are absolute.
8951
8952 The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
8953 @var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
8954 a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
8955 definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8956 For example,
8957
8958 @smallexample
8959 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
8960 @end smallexample
8961 @end defmac
8962
8963 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8964 Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
8965 specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
8966 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
8967 jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_table_data} containing an
8968 @code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
8969
8970 This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
8971 for the table.
8972
8973 If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
8974 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
8975 @end defmac
8976
8977 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
8978 Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
8979 jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
8980 after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
8981 the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
8982 @var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
8983 of the preceding label.
8984
8985 If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
8986 the jump-table.
8987 @end defmac
8988
8989 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl}, int @var{for_eh}, int @var{empty})
8990 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
8991 should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
8992 should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
8993 function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
8994 The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
8995 exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
8996 true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
8997
8998 The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
8999 @end deftypefn
9000
9001 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream})
9002 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
9003 It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
9004 to be broken up according to function.
9005
9006 The default is that no label is emitted.
9007 @end deftypefn
9008
9009 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY (rtx @var{personality})
9010 If the target implements @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT}, this hook may be used to emit a directive to install a personality hook into the unwind info. This hook should not be used if dwarf2 unwind info is used.
9011 @end deftypefn
9012
9013 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT (FILE *@var{stream}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
9014 This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
9015 given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9016 returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
9017 @end deftypefn
9018
9019 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
9020 True if the @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT} hook should be called before the assembly for @var{insn} has been emitted, false if the hook should be called afterward.
9021 @end deftypevr
9022
9023 @node Exception Region Output
9024 @subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
9025
9026 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9027
9028 This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
9029 region.
9030
9031 @defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
9032 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
9033 exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
9034 provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
9035 @file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
9036
9037 You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
9038 unwind information and the default definition does not work.
9039 @end defmac
9040
9041 @defmac EH_FRAME_THROUGH_COLLECT2
9042 If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will identified by
9043 specially named labels. The collect2 process will locate these
9044 labels and generate code to register the frames.
9045
9046 This might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker will not
9047 place the eh_frames in-between the sentinals from @file{crtstuff.c},
9048 or if the system linker does garbage collection and sections cannot
9049 be marked as not to be collected.
9050 @end defmac
9051
9052 @defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
9053 Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
9054 information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
9055 runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
9056 and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
9057 @end defmac
9058
9059 @defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
9060 An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
9061 that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
9062 @end defmac
9063
9064 @defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
9065 Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
9066 information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
9067 Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
9068 @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}),
9069 GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
9070 @end defmac
9071
9072 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
9073 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
9074 by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
9075 should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
9076 @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
9077 should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
9078 information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
9079
9080 A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
9081 This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
9082 default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
9083
9084 Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
9085 not depend on anything except the command-line switches described by
9086 @var{opts}. In particular, the
9087 setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
9088 macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
9089 depending on this setting.
9090
9091 The default implementation of the hook first honors the
9092 @option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
9093 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}. If
9094 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} depends on command-line options, the target
9095 must define this hook so that @var{opts} is used correctly.
9096 @end deftypefn
9097
9098 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
9099 This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
9100 tables even when exceptions are not used. It must not be modified by
9101 command-line option processing.
9102 @end deftypevr
9103
9104 @defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
9105 Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
9106 should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
9107 instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
9108 @end defmac
9109
9110 @defmac JMP_BUF_SIZE
9111 This macro has no effect unless @code{DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP} is also
9112 defined. Define this macro if the default size of @code{jmp_buf} buffer
9113 for the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism
9114 is not large enough, or if it is much too large.
9115 The default size is @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER * sizeof(void *)}.
9116 @end defmac
9117
9118 @defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
9119 This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
9120 function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
9121 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
9122 alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is true, and the positive
9123 minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{SDB and DWARF}. Only applicable if
9124 the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
9125 @end defmac
9126
9127 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
9128 Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
9129 end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
9130 Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
9131 true otherwise.
9132 @end deftypevr
9133
9134 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN (rtx @var{reg})
9135 Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
9136 represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
9137 register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
9138 locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
9139 register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
9140 If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
9141 @end deftypefn
9142
9143 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_DWARF_FRAME_REG_MODE (int @var{regno})
9144 Given a register, this hook should return the mode which the
9145 corresponding Dwarf frame register should have. This is normally
9146 used to return a smaller mode than the raw mode to prevent call
9147 clobbered parts of a register altering the frame register size
9148 @end deftypefn
9149
9150 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA (tree @var{address})
9151 If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
9152 multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
9153 sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
9154 It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
9155 filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
9156 @var{address} is the address of the table.
9157 @end deftypefn
9158
9159 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_TTYPE (rtx @var{sym})
9160 This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
9161 the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
9162 if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
9163 reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
9164 @end deftypefn
9165
9166 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
9167 This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
9168 based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
9169 the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
9170 running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
9171 @end deftypevr
9172
9173 @node Alignment Output
9174 @subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
9175
9176 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9177 This describes commands for alignment.
9178
9179 @defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
9180 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
9181 a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
9182
9183 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9184 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9185 define the macro.
9186
9187 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9188 to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
9189 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9190 selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
9191 @end defmac
9192
9193 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_JUMP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
9194 The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
9195 @code{JUMP_ALIGN}. This works only if
9196 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
9197 @end deftypefn
9198
9199 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
9200 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
9201 a @code{BARRIER}.
9202
9203 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9204 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9205 define the macro.
9206 @end defmac
9207
9208 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
9209 The maximum number of bytes to skip before @var{label} when applying
9210 @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER}. This works only if
9211 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is defined.
9212 @end deftypefn
9213
9214 @defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
9215 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label} that heads
9216 a frequently executed basic block (usually the header of a loop).
9217
9218 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9219 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9220 define the macro.
9221
9222 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9223 to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
9224 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9225 selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
9226 @end defmac
9227
9228 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LOOP_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
9229 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LOOP_ALIGN} to
9230 @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN} is
9231 defined.
9232 @end deftypefn
9233
9234 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
9235 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
9236 If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
9237 the maximum of the specified values is used.
9238
9239 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9240 to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
9241 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9242 selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
9243 @end defmac
9244
9245 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_LABEL_ALIGN_MAX_SKIP (rtx_insn *@var{label})
9246 The maximum number of bytes to skip when applying @code{LABEL_ALIGN}
9247 to @var{label}. This works only if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN}
9248 is defined.
9249 @end deftypefn
9250
9251 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
9252 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9253 instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
9254 Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
9255 expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
9256 @end defmac
9257
9258 @defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
9259 Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
9260 text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
9261 This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
9262 produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
9263 section.
9264 @end defmac
9265
9266 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9267 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9268 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9269 @var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
9270 @end defmac
9271
9272 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9273 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
9274 for padding, if necessary.
9275 @end defmac
9276
9277 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
9278 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9279 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9280 @var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
9281 satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
9282 a C expression of type @code{int}.
9283 @end defmac
9284
9285 @need 3000
9286 @node Debugging Info
9287 @section Controlling Debugging Information Format
9288
9289 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9290 This describes how to specify debugging information.
9291
9292 @menu
9293 * All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
9294 * DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
9295 * DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
9296 * File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
9297 * SDB and DWARF:: Macros for SDB (COFF) and DWARF formats.
9298 * VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
9299 @end menu
9300
9301 @node All Debuggers
9302 @subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9303
9304 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9305 These macros affect all debugging formats.
9306
9307 @defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
9308 A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
9309 register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
9310 of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
9311 some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9312 versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9313 compiler and another for DBX@.
9314
9315 If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
9316 used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9317 consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9318 Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9319 expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9320
9321 If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9322 does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9323 redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
9324 @end defmac
9325
9326 @defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
9327 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9328 variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9329 computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9330 gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9331 that produce debugging output for DBX or COFF-style debugging output
9332 for SDB and allow the frame-pointer to be eliminated when the
9333 @option{-g} options is used.
9334 @end defmac
9335
9336 @defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
9337 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9338 having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9339 @var{offset}.
9340 @end defmac
9341
9342 @defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
9343 A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
9344 produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
9345 this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
9346 debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
9347 @code{SDB_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF_DEBUG}, @code{DWARF2_DEBUG},
9348 @code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG}, and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
9349
9350 When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
9351 value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
9352 exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
9353 value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
9354 defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
9355
9356 The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
9357 user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
9358 @option{-gcoff}, @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
9359 @end defmac
9360
9361 @node DBX Options
9362 @subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9363
9364 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9365 These are specific options for DBX output.
9366
9367 @defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
9368 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
9369 in response to the @option{-g} option.
9370 @end defmac
9371
9372 @defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
9373 Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
9374 in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
9375 @end defmac
9376
9377 @defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
9378 Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
9379 GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9380 debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9381 macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9382 if there is any occasion to.
9383 @end defmac
9384
9385 @defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
9386 Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9387 in the text section.
9388 @end defmac
9389
9390 @defmac ASM_STABS_OP
9391 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9392 use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9393 If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9394 applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9395 @end defmac
9396
9397 @defmac ASM_STABD_OP
9398 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9399 use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9400 value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9401 @code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9402 information format.
9403 @end defmac
9404
9405 @defmac ASM_STABN_OP
9406 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9407 use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9408 name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9409 macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9410 @end defmac
9411
9412 @defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
9413 Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9414 @samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9415 describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9416 On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
9417 @end defmac
9418
9419 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
9420 A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9421 continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9422 exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9423 operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9424 must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9425 with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9426 defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
9427 @end defmac
9428
9429 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
9430 Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9431 the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9432 a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9433 constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9434 if backslash is correct for your system.
9435 @end defmac
9436
9437 @defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
9438 Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9439 outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9440 variable.
9441 @end defmac
9442
9443 @defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
9444 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9445 for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
9446 @end defmac
9447
9448 @defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
9449 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9450 for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9451 provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
9452 @end defmac
9453
9454 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
9455 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9456 for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9457 ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
9458 @end defmac
9459
9460 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
9461 The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9462 passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9463 do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
9464 @end defmac
9465
9466 @defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
9467 Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9468 arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9469 in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9470 code.
9471 @end defmac
9472
9473 @defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9474 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9475 the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9476 relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9477 an absolute address.
9478 @end defmac
9479
9480 @defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9481 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9482 the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9483 start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
9484 @end defmac
9485
9486 @defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
9487 Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
9488 @code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
9489 macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9490 number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
9491 generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9492 number for a type number.
9493 @end defmac
9494
9495 @node DBX Hooks
9496 @subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9497
9498 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9499 These are hooks for DBX format.
9500
9501 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9502 A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9503 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9504 @var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
9505 invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9506 unique labels in the assembly output.
9507
9508 This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9509 if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9510 @end defmac
9511
9512 @defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
9513 Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
9514 @code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
9515 On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9516 disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9517 @end defmac
9518
9519 @defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9520 Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9521 extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9522 feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9523 @end defmac
9524
9525 @node File Names and DBX
9526 @subsection File Names in DBX Format
9527
9528 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9529 This describes file names in DBX format.
9530
9531 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9532 A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
9533 @var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
9534 file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9535 This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9536
9537 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9538 for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
9539
9540 It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9541 text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9542 to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
9543 @var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
9544 @end defmac
9545
9546 @defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9547 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9548 of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9549 the beginning of the file.
9550 @end defmac
9551
9552 @defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
9553 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9554 that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
9555 an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
9556 @samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
9557 @end defmac
9558
9559 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9560 A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
9561 compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
9562 written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9563
9564 If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
9565 of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
9566 @end defmac
9567
9568 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
9569 Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
9570 @code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
9571 the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
9572 whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
9573 @end defmac
9574
9575 @need 2000
9576 @node SDB and DWARF
9577 @subsection Macros for SDB and DWARF Output
9578
9579 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9580 Here are macros for SDB and DWARF output.
9581
9582 @defmac SDB_DEBUGGING_INFO
9583 Define this macro to 1 if GCC should produce COFF-style debugging output
9584 for SDB in response to the @option{-g} option.
9585 @end defmac
9586
9587 @defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
9588 Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
9589 debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
9590
9591 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION (const_tree @var{function})
9592 Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
9593 be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
9594 value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
9595 @end deftypefn
9596
9597 To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
9598 define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
9599 @code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
9600 prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
9601 as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
9602 @end defmac
9603
9604 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
9605 Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
9606 Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9607 (@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
9608 exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
9609 how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
9610 @end defmac
9611
9612 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO (void)
9613 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
9614 unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
9615 @code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
9616 return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
9617
9618 A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
9619 is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
9620
9621 A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
9622 This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
9623 @end deftypefn
9624
9625 @defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
9626 Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
9627 line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
9628 tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
9629 @end defmac
9630
9631 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
9632 True if the @code{.debug_pubtypes} and @code{.debug_pubnames} sections should be emitted. These sections are not used on most platforms, and in particular GDB does not use them.
9633 @end deftypevr
9634
9635 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FORCE_AT_COMP_DIR
9636 True if the @code{DW_AT_comp_dir} attribute should be emitted for each compilation unit. This attribute is required for the darwin linker to emit debug information.
9637 @end deftypevr
9638
9639 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_SCHED2
9640 True if sched2 is not to be run at its normal place.
9641 This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
9642 @end deftypevr
9643
9644 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_VARTRACK
9645 True if vartrack is not to be run at its normal place.
9646 This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
9647 @end deftypevr
9648
9649 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NO_REGISTER_ALLOCATION
9650 True if register allocation and the passes
9651 following it should not be run. Usually true only for virtual assembler
9652 targets.
9653 @end deftypevr
9654
9655 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9656 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9657 @var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9658 @end defmac
9659
9660 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
9661 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
9662 between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g. instruction
9663 slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
9664 @end defmac
9665
9666 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{section})
9667 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
9668 section-relative reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the
9669 given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the given @var{section}.
9670 @end defmac
9671
9672 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9673 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
9674 reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9675 @end defmac
9676
9677 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DATAREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
9678 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to the
9679 given @var{label} relative to the dbase, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
9680 @end defmac
9681
9682 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
9683 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
9684 the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
9685 is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
9686 is referenced by a function.
9687 @end defmac
9688
9689 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{size}, rtx @var{x})
9690 If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
9691 reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
9692 @end deftypefn
9693
9694 @defmac PUT_SDB_@dots{}
9695 Define these macros to override the assembler syntax for the special
9696 SDB assembler directives. See @file{sdbout.c} for a list of these
9697 macros and their arguments. If the standard syntax is used, you need
9698 not define them yourself.
9699 @end defmac
9700
9701 @defmac SDB_DELIM
9702 Some assemblers do not support a semicolon as a delimiter, even between
9703 SDB assembler directives. In that case, define this macro to be the
9704 delimiter to use (usually @samp{\n}). It is not necessary to define
9705 a new set of @code{PUT_SDB_@var{op}} macros if this is the only change
9706 required.
9707 @end defmac
9708
9709 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_UNKNOWN_REFERENCES
9710 Define this macro to allow references to unknown structure,
9711 union, or enumeration tags to be emitted. Standard COFF does not
9712 allow handling of unknown references, MIPS ECOFF has support for
9713 it.
9714 @end defmac
9715
9716 @defmac SDB_ALLOW_FORWARD_REFERENCES
9717 Define this macro to allow references to structure, union, or
9718 enumeration tags that have not yet been seen to be handled. Some
9719 assemblers choke if forward tags are used, while some require it.
9720 @end defmac
9721
9722 @defmac SDB_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line})
9723 A C statement to output SDB debugging information before code for line
9724 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9725 @var{stream}. The default is to emit an @code{.ln} directive.
9726 @end defmac
9727
9728 @need 2000
9729 @node VMS Debug
9730 @subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
9731
9732 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9733 Here are macros for VMS debug format.
9734
9735 @defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
9736 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
9737 in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
9738 is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
9739 @option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
9740 behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
9741 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
9742 @end defmac
9743
9744 @node Floating Point
9745 @section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
9746 @cindex cross compilation and floating point
9747 @cindex floating point and cross compilation
9748
9749 While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
9750 there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
9751 means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
9752 in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
9753 doing the compilation.
9754
9755 Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
9756 range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
9757 the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
9758 safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
9759 the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
9760 emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
9761 target floating point formats are identical.
9762
9763 The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
9764 use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
9765 floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
9766 their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
9767
9768 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
9769 The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
9770 machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
9771 array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
9772 quantity.
9773 @end defmac
9774
9775 @deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9776 Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
9777 @end deftypefn
9778
9779 @deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9780 Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
9781 @var{x} is negative, returns zero.
9782 @end deftypefn
9783
9784 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, machine_mode @var{mode})
9785 Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
9786 representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
9787 decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
9788 defined by the C language for both.
9789 @end deftypefn
9790
9791 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9792 Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
9793 @end deftypefn
9794
9795 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9796 Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
9797 @end deftypefn
9798
9799 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9800 Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
9801 @end deftypefn
9802
9803 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9804 Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
9805 @end deftypefn
9806
9807 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
9808 Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
9809 @end deftypefn
9810
9811 @node Mode Switching
9812 @section Mode Switching Instructions
9813 @cindex mode switching
9814 The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
9815
9816 @defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
9817 Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
9818 switching in an optimizing compilation.
9819
9820 For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
9821 floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
9822 the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
9823 operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
9824 purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
9825 be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you can't put this into instruction emitting
9826 or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
9827
9828 You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
9829 which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
9830 return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
9831 If you define this macro, you also have to define
9832 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{TARGET_MODE_NEEDED},
9833 @code{TARGET_MODE_PRIORITY} and @code{TARGET_MODE_EMIT}.
9834 @code{TARGET_MODE_AFTER}, @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT}
9835 are optional.
9836 @end defmac
9837
9838 @defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
9839 If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
9840 initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
9841 N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
9842 of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
9843 The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
9844 zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
9845 entity in question.
9846 In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
9847 represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
9848 switch is needed / supplied.
9849 @end defmac
9850
9851 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MODE_EMIT (int @var{entity}, int @var{mode}, int @var{prev_mode}, HARD_REG_SET @var{regs_live})
9852 Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}. @var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where the insn(s) are to be inserted. @var{prev_moxde} indicates the mode to switch from. Sets of a lower numbered entity will be emitted before sets of a higher numbered entity to a mode of the same or lower priority.
9853 @end deftypefn
9854
9855 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_NEEDED (int @var{entity}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
9856 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
9857 @end deftypefn
9858
9859 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_AFTER (int @var{entity}, int @var{mode}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
9860 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if different from the incoming mode).
9861 @end deftypefn
9862
9863 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_ENTRY (int @var{entity})
9864 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY} is defined then @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
9865 @end deftypefn
9866
9867 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_EXIT (int @var{entity})
9868 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT} is defined then @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
9869 @end deftypefn
9870
9871 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_PRIORITY (int @var{entity}, int @var{n})
9872 This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed. 0 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority} (@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{} @code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
9873 @end deftypefn
9874
9875 @node Target Attributes
9876 @section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
9877 @cindex target attributes
9878 @cindex machine attributes
9879 @cindex attributes, target-specific
9880
9881 Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
9882 These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
9883 be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
9884
9885 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const struct attribute_spec *} TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
9886 If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
9887 attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree-core.h}) specifying the machine
9888 specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
9889 entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
9890 take.
9891 @end deftypevr
9892
9893 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P (const_tree @var{name})
9894 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
9895 machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
9896 given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
9897 subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
9898 false for all machine-specific attributes.
9899 @end deftypefn
9900
9901 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
9902 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
9903 @var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
9904 and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
9905 generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
9906 supposed always to be compatible.
9907 @end deftypefn
9908
9909 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type})
9910 If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
9911 the newly defined @var{type}.
9912 @end deftypefn
9913
9914 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
9915 Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
9916 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9917 @code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
9918 that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
9919 function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
9920 merging.
9921 @end deftypefn
9922
9923 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{olddecl}, tree @var{newdecl})
9924 Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
9925 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
9926 @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
9927 @var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
9928 when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
9929 attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
9930 call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
9931
9932 @findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
9933 If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
9934 for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
9935 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
9936 will then define a function called
9937 @code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
9938 the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
9939 add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
9940 to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
9941 @samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
9942 @file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
9943 @end deftypefn
9944
9945 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P (const_tree @var{decl})
9946 @var{decl} is a variable or function with @code{__attribute__((dllimport))} specified. Use this hook if the target needs to add extra validation checks to @code{handle_dll_attribute}.
9947 @end deftypefn
9948
9949 @defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
9950 Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
9951 @code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
9952 default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
9953 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
9954 of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
9955 on this implementation detail.
9956 @end defmac
9957
9958 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{node}, tree *@var{attr_ptr})
9959 Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
9960 when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
9961 wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
9962 the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
9963 created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
9964 for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
9965 shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
9966 the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
9967 attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
9968 needed.
9969 @end deftypefn
9970
9971 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P (const_tree @var{fndecl})
9972 @cindex inlining
9973 This target hook returns @code{true} if it is OK to inline @var{fndecl}
9974 into the current function, despite its having target-specific
9975 attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
9976 target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
9977 @end deftypefn
9978
9979 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{name}, tree @var{args}, int @var{flags})
9980 This hook is called to parse @code{attribute(target("..."))}, which
9981 allows setting target-specific options on individual functions.
9982 These function-specific options may differ
9983 from the options specified on the command line. The hook should return
9984 @code{true} if the options are valid.
9985
9986 The hook should set the @code{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
9987 the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target-specific
9988 @code{struct cl_target_option} structure.
9989 @end deftypefn
9990
9991 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_SAVE (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
9992 This hook is called to save any additional target-specific information
9993 in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for function-specific
9994 options from the @code{struct gcc_options} structure.
9995 @xref{Option file format}.
9996 @end deftypefn
9997
9998 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
9999 This hook is called to restore any additional target-specific
10000 information in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for
10001 function-specific options to the @code{struct gcc_options} structure.
10002 @end deftypefn
10003
10004 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_POST_STREAM_IN (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
10005 This hook is called to update target-specific information in the
10006 @code{struct cl_target_option} structure after it is streamed in from
10007 LTO bytecode.
10008 @end deftypefn
10009
10010 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_PRINT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{indent}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
10011 This hook is called to print any additional target-specific
10012 information in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for
10013 function-specific options.
10014 @end deftypefn
10015
10016 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE (tree @var{args}, tree @var{pop_target})
10017 This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC target}, which
10018 sets the target-specific options for functions that occur later in the
10019 input stream. The options accepted should be the same as those handled by the
10020 @code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
10021 @end deftypefn
10022
10023 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE (void)
10024 Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
10025 a particular target machine. You can override the hook
10026 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
10027 once just after all the command options have been parsed.
10028
10029 Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
10030 @option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
10031
10032 If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
10033 changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
10034 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
10035 @end deftypefn
10036
10037 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_FUNCTION_VERSIONS (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2})
10038 This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are
10039 versions of the same function. @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are function
10040 versions if and only if they have the same function signature and
10041 different target specific attributes, that is, they are compiled for
10042 different target machines.
10043 @end deftypefn
10044
10045 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P (tree @var{caller}, tree @var{callee})
10046 This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
10047 cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
10048 default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
10049 specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
10050 @end deftypefn
10051
10052 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_RELAYOUT_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl})
10053 This target hook fixes function @var{fndecl} after attributes are processed. Default does nothing. On ARM, the default function's alignment is updated with the attribute target.
10054 @end deftypefn
10055
10056 @node Emulated TLS
10057 @section Emulating TLS
10058 @cindex Emulated TLS
10059
10060 For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
10061 specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
10062 used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
10063 configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
10064 the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
10065 layer.
10066
10067 The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
10068 object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
10069 which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
10070 address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
10071
10072 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
10073 Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
10074 object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
10075 emulated TLS helper function to be used.
10076 @end deftypevr
10077
10078 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
10079 Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
10080 program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
10081 initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
10082 have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
10083 registration function to be used.
10084 @end deftypevr
10085
10086 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
10087 Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
10088 be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
10089 any section.
10090 @end deftypevr
10091
10092 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
10093 Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
10094 placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
10095 section.
10096 @end deftypevr
10097
10098 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
10099 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
10100 The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
10101 @end deftypevr
10102
10103 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
10104 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
10105 default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
10106 @end deftypevr
10107
10108 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS (tree @var{type}, tree *@var{name})
10109 Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
10110 object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
10111 @var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
10112 @code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
10113 for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
10114 @end deftypefn
10115
10116 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT (tree @var{var}, tree @var{decl}, tree @var{tmpl_addr})
10117 Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
10118 TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
10119 is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
10120 initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
10121 @end deftypefn
10122
10123 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
10124 Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
10125 fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
10126 single objects. The default is false.
10127 @end deftypevr
10128
10129 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
10130 Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
10131 may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
10132 @end deftypevr
10133
10134 @node MIPS Coprocessors
10135 @section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
10136 @cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
10137
10138 The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
10139 coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
10140 accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
10141 and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
10142
10143 @smallexample
10144 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
10145 unsigned int d;
10146
10147 d = cp0count + 3;
10148 @end smallexample
10149
10150 (``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
10151 names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
10152 overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
10153
10154 Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
10155 be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
10156 later in the function.
10157
10158 Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
10159 the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
10160 floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
10161
10162 @node PCH Target
10163 @section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
10164 @cindex parameters, precompiled headers
10165
10166 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY (size_t *@var{sz})
10167 This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
10168 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
10169 @samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
10170 @end deftypefn
10171
10172 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_PCH_VALID_P (const void *@var{data}, size_t @var{sz})
10173 This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
10174 compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
10175 if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
10176 be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
10177
10178 @var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
10179 when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
10180 It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
10181 compiler, so no format checking is needed.
10182
10183 The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
10184 suitable for most targets.
10185 @end deftypefn
10186
10187 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS (int @var{pch_flags})
10188 If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
10189 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
10190 of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
10191 @code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
10192 value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
10193 @end deftypefn
10194
10195 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_PREPARE_PCH_SAVE (void)
10196 Called before writing out a PCH file. If the target has some
10197 garbage-collected data that needs to be in a particular state on PCH loads,
10198 it can use this hook to enforce that state. Very few targets need
10199 to do anything here.
10200 @end deftypefn
10201
10202 @node C++ ABI
10203 @section C++ ABI parameters
10204 @cindex parameters, c++ abi
10205
10206 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE (void)
10207 Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
10208 These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
10209 default is long_long_integer_type_node.
10210 @end deftypefn
10211
10212 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT (void)
10213 This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
10214 @code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
10215 @code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
10216 @end deftypefn
10217
10218 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE (tree @var{type})
10219 This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
10220 whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
10221 known that a cookie is needed. The default is
10222 @code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
10223 IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
10224 @end deftypefn
10225
10226 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE (void)
10227 This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
10228 array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
10229 @end deftypefn
10230
10231 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS (tree @var{type}, int @var{import_export})
10232 If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
10233 class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
10234 will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
10235 to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
10236 modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
10237 backend's targeted operating system.
10238 @end deftypefn
10239
10240 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS (void)
10241 This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
10242 the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
10243 @code{false}.
10244 @end deftypefn
10245
10246 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE (void)
10247 This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
10248 which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
10249 table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
10250 Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
10251 the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
10252 some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
10253 method. The default is to return @code{true}.
10254 @end deftypefn
10255
10256 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl})
10257 @var{decl} is a virtual table, virtual table table, typeinfo object, or other similar implicit class data object that will be emitted with external linkage in this translation unit. No ELF visibility has been explicitly specified. If the target needs to specify a visibility other than that of the containing class, use this hook to set @code{DECL_VISIBILITY} and @code{DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED}.
10258 @end deftypefn
10259
10260 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT (void)
10261 This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
10262 similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
10263 external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
10264 classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
10265 unit will not be COMDAT.
10266 @end deftypefn
10267
10268 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT (void)
10269 This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10270 the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10271 be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10272 @end deftypefn
10273
10274 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT (void)
10275 This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10276 should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10277 is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10278 @end deftypefn
10279
10280 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT (void)
10281 This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10282 in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10283 destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10284 shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10285 unloaded. The default is to return false.
10286 @end deftypefn
10287
10288 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION (tree @var{type})
10289 @var{type} is a C++ class (i.e., RECORD_TYPE or UNION_TYPE) that has just been defined. Use this hook to make adjustments to the class (eg, tweak visibility or perform any other required target modifications).
10290 @end deftypefn
10291
10292 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_DECL_MANGLING_CONTEXT (const_tree @var{decl})
10293 Return target-specific mangling context of @var{decl} or @code{NULL_TREE}.
10294 @end deftypefn
10295
10296 @node Named Address Spaces
10297 @section Adding support for named address spaces
10298 @cindex named address spaces
10299
10300 The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10301 standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10302 support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10303 processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
10304 GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10305 address spaces other than the default address space. These address
10306 spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10307 @code{const} type attributes.
10308
10309 Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
10310 pointers to the generic address space.
10311
10312 For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10313 to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10314 processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10315 issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10316 local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10317 address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10318 @option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10319 always 32 bits).
10320
10321 Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10322 range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10323 address space.
10324
10325 To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10326 the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10327 the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10328 named address space #1:
10329 @smallexample
10330 #define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
10331 c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
10332 @end smallexample
10333
10334 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10335 Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10336 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10337 The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode}.
10338 @end deftypefn
10339
10340 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10341 Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10342 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10343 The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode}.
10344 @end deftypefn
10345
10346 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10347 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10348 with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10349 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10350 except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10351 version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10352 @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10353 target hooks for the given address space.
10354 @end deftypefn
10355
10356 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{exp}, bool @var{strict}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10357 Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10358 @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10359 parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10360 finished. This target hook is the same as the
10361 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10362 explicit named address space support.
10363 @end deftypefn
10364
10365 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10366 Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10367 with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10368 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10369 except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10370 @end deftypefn
10371
10372 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P (addr_space_t @var{subset}, addr_space_t @var{superset})
10373 Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10374 contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10375 a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10376 will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10377 arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
10378 converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
10379 @end deftypefn
10380
10381 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ZERO_ADDRESS_VALID (addr_space_t @var{as})
10382 Define this to modify the default handling of address 0 for the
10383 address space. Return true if 0 should be considered a valid address.
10384 @end deftypefn
10385
10386 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT (rtx @var{op}, tree @var{from_type}, tree @var{to_type})
10387 Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10388 @var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10389 space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10390 to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10391 guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10392 as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10393 @end deftypefn
10394
10395 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_DEBUG (addr_space_t @var{as})
10396 Define this to define how the address space is encoded in dwarf.
10397 The result is the value to be used with @code{DW_AT_address_class}.
10398 @end deftypefn
10399
10400 @node Misc
10401 @section Miscellaneous Parameters
10402 @cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10403
10404 @c prevent bad page break with this line
10405 Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10406
10407 @defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10408 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10409 has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10410 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10411 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10412 set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10413 to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10414 @end defmac
10415
10416 @defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10417 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10418 has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10419 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10420 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10421 set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10422 to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
10423 @end defmac
10424
10425 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
10426 An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10427 elements of a jump-table should have.
10428 @end defmac
10429
10430 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
10431 Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10432 when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10433 it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
10434 To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
10435 make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
10436 The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
10437 flags can be updated.
10438 @end defmac
10439
10440 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
10441 Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
10442 should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10443 jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10444 contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10445 is in effect.
10446 @end defmac
10447
10448 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD (void)
10449 This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
10450 is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10451 The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10452 five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
10453 @end deftypefn
10454
10455 @defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
10456 Define this macro to 1 if operations between registers with integral mode
10457 smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register.
10458 Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
10459 @end defmac
10460
10461 @defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
10462 Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
10463 memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10464 bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
10465 zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
10466 of @var{mem_mode} for which the
10467 insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
10468 @code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
10469
10470 This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
10471 greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10472 value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
10473 @code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
10474 define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
10475
10476 You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
10477 the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10478 of these hard registers @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero
10479 when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10480 integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10481
10482 You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
10483 mode, @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10484 @code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10485 is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
10486 @end defmac
10487
10488 @defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
10489 Define this macro to 1 if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10490 extends.
10491 @end defmac
10492
10493 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL (machine_mode @var{mode})
10494 When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10495 divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10496 the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10497 that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10498 of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10499 has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10500 @end deftypefn
10501
10502 @defmac MOVE_MAX
10503 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10504 between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
10505 @end defmac
10506
10507 @defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
10508 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10509 between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
10510 is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
10511 constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10512 at run-time.
10513 @end defmac
10514
10515 @defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
10516 A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
10517 actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
10518 of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
10519 this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
10520 a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
10521 truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
10522 instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
10523 include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10524 also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
10525 arguments to bit-field instructions.
10526
10527 If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
10528 position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
10529 instructions exist, you should define this macro.
10530
10531 However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
10532 only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
10533 bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
10534 such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
10535 the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
10536
10537 You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
10538 @end defmac
10539
10540 @anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
10541 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK (machine_mode @var{mode})
10542 This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
10543 deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
10544 @xref{shift patterns}.
10545
10546 On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
10547 shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
10548 equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
10549 this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
10550 otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
10551 particular behavior is guaranteed.
10552
10553 Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
10554 @emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
10555 that are generated by the named shift patterns.
10556
10557 The default implementation of this function returns
10558 @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
10559 and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
10560 @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
10561 nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
10562 by overriding it.
10563 @end deftypefn
10564
10565 @defmac TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (@var{outprec}, @var{inprec})
10566 A C expression which is nonzero if on this machine it is safe to
10567 ``convert'' an integer of @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec}
10568 bits (where @var{outprec} is smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely
10569 operating on it as if it had only @var{outprec} bits.
10570
10571 On many machines, this expression can be 1.
10572
10573 @c rearranged this, removed the phrase "it is reported that". this was
10574 @c to fix an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
10575 When @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} returns 1 for a pair of sizes for
10576 modes for which @code{MODES_TIEABLE_P} is 0, suboptimal code can result.
10577 If this is the case, making @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} return 0 in
10578 such cases may improve things.
10579 @end defmac
10580
10581 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (machine_mode @var{mode}, machine_mode @var{rep_mode})
10582 The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
10583 are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
10584 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
10585 sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
10586 otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
10587 representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
10588 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
10589 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
10590 @var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
10591 widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
10592
10593 Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
10594 value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
10595 as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
10596 @code{CANNOT_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns nonzero.
10597
10598 Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
10599 describe two related properties. If you define
10600 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
10601 to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
10602 extension.
10603
10604 In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
10605 @code{TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
10606 @code{mode}.
10607 @end deftypefn
10608
10609 @defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
10610 A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
10611 with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
10612 (@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
10613 apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
10614 comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
10615
10616 A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
10617 comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
10618 and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
10619 which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
10620 true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
10621 operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
10622 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
10623 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
10624 the compiler.
10625
10626 If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
10627 generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
10628 replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
10629 the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
10630 For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
10631 @code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
10632 @samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
10633 expression
10634
10635 @smallexample
10636 (ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
10637 @end smallexample
10638
10639 @noindent
10640 can be converted to
10641
10642 @smallexample
10643 (ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
10644 @end smallexample
10645
10646 @noindent
10647 where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
10648 tested into the sign bit.
10649
10650 There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
10651 for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
10652 but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
10653 are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
10654 perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
10655 comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
10656
10657 Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
10658 from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
10659 choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
10660 to be used:
10661
10662 @itemize @bullet
10663 @item
10664 Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
10665 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
10666 ``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
10667 comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
10668 combine the normalization with other operations.
10669
10670 @item
10671 For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
10672 slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
10673 other machines.
10674
10675 @item
10676 As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
10677 exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
10678 others.
10679
10680 @item
10681 Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
10682 @end itemize
10683
10684 Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
10685 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
10686 instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
10687 those cases, e.g., one matching
10688
10689 @smallexample
10690 (set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
10691 @end smallexample
10692
10693 Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
10694 condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
10695 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
10696 machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
10697 and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
10698 @code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
10699 @file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptimizer can be used to
10700 find such instruction sequences on other machines.
10701
10702 If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
10703 not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
10704 instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
10705 @end defmac
10706
10707 @defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10708 A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
10709 returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
10710 Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
10711 floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
10712 this macro.
10713 @end defmac
10714
10715 @defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
10716 A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
10717 for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
10718 mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
10719 this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
10720 return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
10721 this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
10722 @code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
10723 the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
10724 given mode.
10725 @end defmac
10726
10727 @defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10728 @defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
10729 A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
10730 for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
10731 A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
10732 If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
10733 evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
10734 entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
10735 the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
10736 In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
10737 this value.
10738
10739 If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
10740 @code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
10741
10742 This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
10743 relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
10744 is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
10745 to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
10746
10747 Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
10748 and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
10749 visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
10750 to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
10751 breaking the API@.
10752 @end defmac
10753
10754 @defmac Pmode
10755 An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
10756 this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
10757 pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
10758 On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
10759 modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
10760
10761 The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
10762 @code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
10763 @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
10764 to @code{Pmode}.
10765 @end defmac
10766
10767 @defmac FUNCTION_MODE
10768 An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
10769 being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
10770 where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
10771 @code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
10772 size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
10773 as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
10774 @end defmac
10775
10776 @defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
10777 In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
10778 constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
10779 hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
10780 where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
10781 strict conformance to the C Standard.
10782
10783 Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
10784 convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
10785 files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
10786 @end defmac
10787
10788 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_C_PREINCLUDE (void)
10789 Define this hook to return the name of a header file to be included at the start of all compilations, as if it had been included with @code{#include <@var{file}>}. If this hook returns @code{NULL}, or is not defined, or the header is not found, or if the user specifies @option{-ffreestanding} or @option{-nostdinc}, no header is included.
10790
10791 This hook can be used together with a header provided by the system C library to implement ISO C requirements for certain macros to be predefined that describe properties of the whole implementation rather than just the compiler.
10792 @end deftypefn
10793
10794 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C (const char*@var{})
10795 Define this hook to add target-specific C++ implicit extern C functions. If this function returns true for the name of a file-scope function, that function implicitly gets extern "C" linkage rather than whatever language linkage the declaration would normally have. An example of such function is WinMain on Win32 targets.
10796 @end deftypefn
10797
10798 @defmac NO_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
10799 Define this macro if the system header files support C++ as well as C@.
10800 This macro inhibits the usual method of using system header files in
10801 C++, which is to pretend that the file's contents are enclosed in
10802 @samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
10803 @end defmac
10804
10805 @findex #pragma
10806 @findex pragma
10807 @defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
10808 Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
10809 If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
10810 @code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
10811 for each pragma. The macro may also do any
10812 setup required for the pragmas.
10813
10814 The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
10815 other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
10816 definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
10817
10818 If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
10819 defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
10820
10821 Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
10822 @samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
10823 silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
10824 @end defmac
10825
10826 @deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10827 @deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
10828
10829 Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
10830 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
10831 @var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
10832 pragma of the form
10833
10834 @smallexample
10835 #pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
10836 @end smallexample
10837
10838 @var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
10839 @code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
10840 routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
10841 on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
10842 @var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
10843 callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
10844 a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
10845 arguments of pragmas registered with
10846 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
10847 pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
10848
10849 Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
10850 compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
10851 other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
10852 to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
10853 building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
10854 variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
10855 target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
10856 the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
10857 code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
10858 rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
10859 how to build this object file.
10860 @end deftypefun
10861
10862 @defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
10863 Define this macro if macros should be expanded in the
10864 arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
10865 @end defmac
10866
10867 @defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
10868 If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
10869 the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
10870 This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
10871 @samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
10872 @end defmac
10873
10874 @defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
10875 Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
10876 identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
10877 not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
10878 there is no need to define this macro in that case.
10879 @end defmac
10880
10881 @defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10882 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10883 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10884 even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
10885 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
10886 every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
10887 or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
10888 you should define this macro.
10889
10890 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10891 @end defmac
10892
10893 @defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
10894 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
10895 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
10896 even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
10897 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
10898 some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
10899 are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
10900 define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
10901 instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
10902 slot of @var{insn}.
10903
10904 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
10905 @end defmac
10906
10907 @defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
10908 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
10909 global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
10910 symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
10911 instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
10912 from shared libraries (DLLs).
10913
10914 You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
10915 @end defmac
10916
10917 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {rtx_insn *} TARGET_MD_ASM_ADJUST (vec<rtx>& @var{outputs}, vec<rtx>& @var{inputs}, vec<const char *>& @var{constraints}, vec<rtx>& @var{clobbers}, HARD_REG_SET& @var{clobbered_regs})
10918 This target hook may add @dfn{clobbers} to @var{clobbers} and
10919 @var{clobbered_regs} for any hard regs the port wishes to automatically
10920 clobber for an asm. The @var{outputs} and @var{inputs} may be inspected
10921 to avoid clobbering a register that is already used by the asm.
10922
10923 It may modify the @var{outputs}, @var{inputs}, and @var{constraints}
10924 as necessary for other pre-processing. In this case the return value is
10925 a sequence of insns to emit after the asm.
10926 @end deftypefn
10927
10928 @defmac MATH_LIBRARY
10929 Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
10930 in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
10931 @samp{""} if the target does not have a
10932 separate math library.
10933
10934 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
10935 @end defmac
10936
10937 @defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
10938 Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
10939 specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
10940
10941 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
10942 is wrong.
10943 @end defmac
10944
10945 @defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
10946 Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
10947 functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
10948 Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
10949 to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
10950 if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
10951 for cross-profiling.
10952 @end defmac
10953
10954 @defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
10955
10956 A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
10957 conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
10958 @code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
10959 1 if it does use cc0.
10960 @end defmac
10961
10962 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10963 Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
10964 conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
10965 @var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
10966 contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
10967 and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
10968 then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
10969 @var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
10970 @end defmac
10971
10972 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
10973 Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
10974 if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
10975 @var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
10976 being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
10977 @end defmac
10978
10979 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
10980 A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
10981 be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
10982 a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
10983 about the currently processed blocks.
10984 @end defmac
10985
10986 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
10987 A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
10988 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10989 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10990 to by @var{ce_info}.
10991 @end defmac
10992
10993 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
10994 A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
10995 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
10996 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
10997 to by @var{ce_info}.
10998 @end defmac
10999
11000 @defmac IFCVT_MACHDEP_INIT (@var{ce_info})
11001 A C expression to initialize any machine specific data for if-conversion
11002 of the if-block in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
11003 to by @var{ce_info}.
11004 @end defmac
11005
11006 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG (void)
11007 If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
11008 instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
11009 just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
11010
11011 The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
11012 it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
11013 laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
11014 Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
11015
11016 You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
11017 definition is null.
11018 @end deftypefn
11019
11020 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS (void)
11021 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
11022 that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
11023 necessary setup.
11024
11025 Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
11026 instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
11027 they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
11028 instructions or prefetch instructions).
11029
11030 To create a built-in function, call the function
11031 @code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
11032 which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
11033 up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes};
11034 only language front ends that use those two functions will call
11035 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
11036 @end deftypefn
11037
11038 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL (unsigned @var{code}, bool @var{initialize_p})
11039 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
11040 that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
11041 builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
11042 If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
11043 if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
11044 If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
11045 @code{error_mark_node}.
11046 @end deftypefn
11047
11048 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN (tree @var{exp}, rtx @var{target}, rtx @var{subtarget}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{ignore})
11049
11050 Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
11051 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
11052 function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
11053 convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
11054 @var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
11055 @var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
11056 ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
11057 built-in function.
11058 @end deftypefn
11059
11060 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_CHKP_FUNCTION (unsigned @var{fcode})
11061 This hook allows target to redefine built-in functions used by
11062 Pointer Bounds Checker for code instrumentation. Hook should return
11063 fndecl of function implementing generic builtin whose code is
11064 passed in @var{fcode}. Currently following built-in functions are
11065 obtained using this hook:
11066 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_bndmk (const void *@var{lb}, size_t @var{size})
11067 Function code - BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDMK. This built-in function is used
11068 by Pointer Bounds Checker to create bound values. @var{lb} holds low
11069 bound of the resulting bounds. @var{size} holds size of created bounds.
11070 @end deftypefn
11071
11072 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} void __chkp_bndstx (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b}, const void **@var{loc})
11073 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDSTX}. This built-in function is used
11074 by Pointer Bounds Checker to store bounds @var{b} for pointer @var{ptr}
11075 when @var{ptr} is stored by address @var{loc}.
11076 @end deftypefn
11077
11078 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_bndldx (const void **@var{loc}, const void *@var{ptr})
11079 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDLDX}. This built-in function is used
11080 by Pointer Bounds Checker to get bounds of pointer @var{ptr} loaded by
11081 address @var{loc}.
11082 @end deftypefn
11083
11084 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} void __chkp_bndcl (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b})
11085 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDCL}. This built-in function is used
11086 by Pointer Bounds Checker to perform check for pointer @var{ptr} against
11087 lower bound of bounds @var{b}.
11088 @end deftypefn
11089
11090 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} void __chkp_bndcu (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b})
11091 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDCU}. This built-in function is used
11092 by Pointer Bounds Checker to perform check for pointer @var{ptr} against
11093 upper bound of bounds @var{b}.
11094 @end deftypefn
11095
11096 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_bndret (void *@var{ptr})
11097 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_BNDRET}. This built-in function is used
11098 by Pointer Bounds Checker to obtain bounds returned by a call statement.
11099 @var{ptr} passed to built-in is @code{SSA_NAME} returned by the call.
11100 @end deftypefn
11101
11102 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_intersect (__bounds_type @var{b1}, __bounds_type @var{b2})
11103 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_INTERSECT}. This built-in function
11104 returns intersection of bounds @var{b1} and @var{b2}.
11105 @end deftypefn
11106
11107 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} __bounds_type __chkp_narrow (const void *@var{ptr}, __bounds_type @var{b}, size_t @var{s})
11108 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_NARROW}. This built-in function
11109 returns intersection of bounds @var{b} and
11110 [@var{ptr}, @var{ptr} + @var{s} - @code{1}].
11111 @end deftypefn
11112
11113 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} size_t __chkp_sizeof (const void *@var{ptr})
11114 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_SIZEOF}. This built-in function
11115 returns size of object referenced by @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} is always
11116 @code{ADDR_EXPR} of @code{VAR_DECL}. This built-in is used by
11117 Pointer Bounds Checker when bounds of object cannot be computed statically
11118 (e.g. object has incomplete type).
11119 @end deftypefn
11120
11121 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} const void *__chkp_extract_lower (__bounds_type @var{b})
11122 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_EXTRACT_LOWER}. This built-in function
11123 returns lower bound of bounds @var{b}.
11124 @end deftypefn
11125
11126 @deftypefn {Built-in Function} const void *__chkp_extract_upper (__bounds_type @var{b})
11127 Function code - @code{BUILT_IN_CHKP_EXTRACT_UPPER}. This built-in function
11128 returns upper bound of bounds @var{b}.
11129 @end deftypefn
11130 @end deftypefn
11131 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CHKP_BOUND_TYPE (void)
11132 Return type to be used for bounds
11133 @end deftypefn
11134 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum machine_mode} TARGET_CHKP_BOUND_MODE (void)
11135 Return mode to be used for bounds.
11136 @end deftypefn
11137 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CHKP_MAKE_BOUNDS_CONSTANT (HOST_WIDE_INT @var{lb}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{ub})
11138 Return constant used to statically initialize constant bounds
11139 with specified lower bound @var{lb} and upper bounds @var{ub}.
11140 @end deftypefn
11141 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CHKP_INITIALIZE_BOUNDS (tree @var{var}, tree @var{lb}, tree @var{ub}, tree *@var{stmts})
11142 Generate a list of statements @var{stmts} to initialize pointer
11143 bounds variable @var{var} with bounds @var{lb} and @var{ub}. Return
11144 the number of generated statements.
11145 @end deftypefn
11146
11147 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN (unsigned int @var{loc}, tree @var{fndecl}, void *@var{arglist})
11148 Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
11149 was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
11150 @emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
11151 implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
11152 declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
11153 arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
11154 complete expression that implements the operation, usually
11155 another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
11156 @var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
11157 @end deftypefn
11158
11159 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{n_args}, tree *@var{argp}, bool @var{ignore})
11160 Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
11161 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
11162 built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
11163 the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
11164 The result is another tree, valid for both GIMPLE and GENERIC,
11165 containing a simplified expression for the call's result. If
11166 @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
11167 @end deftypefn
11168
11169 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GIMPLE_FOLD_BUILTIN (gimple_stmt_iterator *@var{gsi})
11170 Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up
11171 by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{gsi} points to the gimple
11172 statement holding the function call. Returns true if any change
11173 was made to the GIMPLE stream.
11174 @end deftypefn
11175
11176 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMPARE_VERSION_PRIORITY (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2})
11177 This hook is used to compare the target attributes in two functions to
11178 determine which function's features get higher priority. This is used
11179 during function multi-versioning to figure out the order in which two
11180 versions must be dispatched. A function version with a higher priority
11181 is checked for dispatching earlier. @var{decl1} and @var{decl2} are
11182 the two function decls that will be compared.
11183 @end deftypefn
11184
11185 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GET_FUNCTION_VERSIONS_DISPATCHER (void *@var{decl})
11186 This hook is used to get the dispatcher function for a set of function
11187 versions. The dispatcher function is called to invoke the right function
11188 version at run-time. @var{decl} is one version from a set of semantically
11189 identical versions.
11190 @end deftypefn
11191
11192 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GENERATE_VERSION_DISPATCHER_BODY (void *@var{arg})
11193 This hook is used to generate the dispatcher logic to invoke the right
11194 function version at run-time for a given set of function versions.
11195 @var{arg} points to the callgraph node of the dispatcher function whose
11196 body must be generated.
11197 @end deftypefn
11198
11199 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_USE_DOLOOP_P (const widest_int @var{&iterations}, const widest_int @var{&iterations_max}, unsigned int @var{loop_depth}, bool @var{entered_at_top})
11200 Return true if it is possible to use low-overhead loops (@code{doloop_end}
11201 and @code{doloop_begin}) for a particular loop. @var{iterations} gives the
11202 exact number of iterations, or 0 if not known. @var{iterations_max} gives
11203 the maximum number of iterations, or 0 if not known. @var{loop_depth} is
11204 the nesting depth of the loop, with 1 for innermost loops, 2 for loops that
11205 contain innermost loops, and so on. @var{entered_at_top} is true if the
11206 loop is only entered from the top.
11207
11208 This hook is only used if @code{doloop_end} is available. The default
11209 implementation returns true. You can use @code{can_use_doloop_if_innermost}
11210 if the loop must be the innermost, and if there are no other restrictions.
11211 @end deftypefn
11212
11213 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP (const rtx_insn *@var{insn})
11214
11215 Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
11216 low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
11217 could not be applied.
11218
11219 Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
11220 instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
11221 the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
11222 By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
11223 loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
11224 @end deftypefn
11225
11226 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_COMBINED_INSN (rtx_insn *@var{insn})
11227 Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return @code{false} if the instruction is not appropriate as a combination of two or more instructions. The default is to accept all instructions.
11228 @end deftypefn
11229
11230 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_FOLLOW_JUMP (const rtx_insn *@var{follower}, const rtx_insn *@var{followee})
11231 FOLLOWER and FOLLOWEE are JUMP_INSN instructions; return true if FOLLOWER may be modified to follow FOLLOWEE; false, if it can't. For example, on some targets, certain kinds of branches can't be made to follow through a hot/cold partitioning.
11232 @end deftypefn
11233
11234 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P (const_rtx @var{x}, int @var{outer_code})
11235 This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
11236 Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
11237 PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
11238 of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
11239 @end deftypefn
11240
11241 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE (rtx @var{hard_reg})
11242
11243 When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
11244 register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
11245 to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
11246 it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
11247 is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
11248 that had its initial value copied by using
11249 @code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
11250 Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
11251 to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
11252 the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
11253 @code{MEM}.
11254 If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
11255 it might decide to use another register anyways.
11256 You may use @code{current_function_is_leaf} or
11257 @code{REG_N_SETS} in the hook to determine if the hard
11258 register in question will not be clobbered.
11259 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
11260 allocation.
11261 @end deftypefn
11262
11263 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P (const_rtx @var{x}, unsigned @var{flags})
11264 This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
11265 @code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
11266 this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
11267 @code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
11268 to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
11269 passed along.
11270 @end deftypefn
11271
11272 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION (tree @var{decl})
11273 The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
11274 context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
11275 the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
11276 per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
11277 attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
11278 The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
11279 and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
11280 and is returning to processing at the top level.
11281 The default hook function does nothing.
11282
11283 GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
11284 some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
11285 situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
11286 or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
11287 @code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
11288 outside of any function scope.
11289 @end deftypefn
11290
11291 @defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
11292 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
11293 files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
11294 use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
11295 @end defmac
11296
11297 @defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
11298 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
11299 automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
11300 do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
11301 executable files.
11302 @end defmac
11303
11304 @defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
11305 If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
11306 specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
11307 Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
11308 object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
11309 lists.
11310 @end defmac
11311
11312 @defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
11313 Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
11314 method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
11315 must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
11316 For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
11317 the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
11318 defined as this expression:
11319
11320 @smallexample
11321 build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
11322 build_tree_list
11323 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
11324 NULL))
11325 @end smallexample
11326 @end defmac
11327
11328 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P (void)
11329 This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
11330 instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
11331 every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
11332 reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
11333
11334 @smallexample
11335 static bool
11336 cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
11337 @{
11338 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
11339 @}
11340 @end smallexample
11341 @end deftypefn
11342
11343 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS (void)
11344 This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
11345 optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
11346 usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
11347 re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
11348 to inter-block scheduling.
11349 @end deftypefn
11350
11351 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED (bool @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen})
11352 Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
11353 registers
11354 that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
11355 returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
11356 that all target registers in the class returned by
11357 @samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
11358 saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
11359 epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
11360 true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
11361 to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
11362 to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
11363 @end deftypefn
11364
11365 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION (void)
11366 This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
11367 This target hook is required only when the target has several different
11368 modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
11369 @end deftypefn
11370
11371 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GEN_CCMP_FIRST (rtx *@var{prep_seq}, rtx *@var{gen_seq}, int @var{code}, tree @var{op0}, tree @var{op1})
11372 This function prepares to emit a comparison insn for the first compare in a
11373 sequence of conditional comparisions. It returns an appropriate comparison
11374 with @code{CC} for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}.
11375 The insns to prepare the compare are saved in @var{prep_seq} and the compare
11376 insns are saved in @var{gen_seq}. They will be emitted when all the
11377 compares in the the conditional comparision are generated without error.
11378 @var{code} is the @code{rtx_code} of the compare for @var{op0} and @var{op1}.
11379 @end deftypefn
11380
11381 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GEN_CCMP_NEXT (rtx *@var{prep_seq}, rtx *@var{gen_seq}, rtx @var{prev}, int @var{cmp_code}, tree @var{op0}, tree @var{op1}, int @var{bit_code})
11382 This function prepares to emit a conditional comparison within a sequence
11383 of conditional comparisons. It returns an appropriate comparison with
11384 @code{CC} for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}.
11385 The insns to prepare the compare are saved in @var{prep_seq} and the compare
11386 insns are saved in @var{gen_seq}. They will be emitted when all the
11387 compares in the conditional comparision are generated without error. The
11388 @var{prev} expression is the result of a prior call to @code{gen_ccmp_first}
11389 or @code{gen_ccmp_next}. It may return @code{NULL} if the combination of
11390 @var{prev} and this comparison is not supported, otherwise the result must
11391 be appropriate for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}.
11392 @var{code} is the @code{rtx_code} of the compare for @var{op0} and @var{op1}.
11393 @var{bit_code} is @code{AND} or @code{IOR}, which is the op on the compares.
11394 @end deftypefn
11395
11396 @deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST (unsigned @var{nunroll}, struct loop *@var{loop})
11397 This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
11398 should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
11399 the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
11400 the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
11401 is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
11402 number of memory accesses.
11403 @end deftypefn
11404
11405 @defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
11406 If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
11407 that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
11408 that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
11409 constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
11410 more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
11411 system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
11412 The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
11413 @end defmac
11414
11415 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11416 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11417 target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
11418 are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11419 The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11420 @end deftypefn
11421
11422 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11423 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11424 target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
11425 indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
11426 @var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
11427 @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11428 @end deftypefn
11429
11430 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11431 This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11432 The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
11433 systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11434 that are different from @option{-I}.
11435 @end deftypefn
11436
11437 @defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11438 This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
11439 for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
11440 @code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
11441 functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
11442 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
11443 @end defmac
11444
11445 @defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11446 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11447 target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11448 option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11449 @end defmac
11450
11451 @defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11452 If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11453 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11454 @end defmac
11455
11456 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11457 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11458 target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11459 default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11460 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11461 @end defmac
11462
11463 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11464 If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11465 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11466 @end defmac
11467
11468 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11469 If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11470 routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11471 and scanf formatter settings.
11472 @end defmac
11473
11474 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN (const_tree @var{typelist}, const_tree @var{funcdecl}, const_tree @var{val})
11475 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11476 illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
11477 with prototype @var{typelist}.
11478 @end deftypefn
11479
11480 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION (const_tree @var{fromtype}, const_tree @var{totype})
11481 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11482 invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11483 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11484 @end deftypefn
11485
11486 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type})
11487 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11488 invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11489 @code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11490 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11491 @end deftypefn
11492
11493 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
11494 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11495 invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11496 and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11497 the front end.
11498 @end deftypefn
11499
11500 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_PARAMETER_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11501 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11502 invalid for functions to include parameters of type @var{type},
11503 or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11504 the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11505 @end deftypefn
11506
11507 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_RETURN_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11508 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11509 invalid for functions to have return type @var{type},
11510 or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11511 the front end. This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11512 @end deftypefn
11513
11514 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11515 If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11516 @var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
11517 analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11518 front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11519 target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11520 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11521 @end deftypefn
11522
11523 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE (tree @var{type}, tree @var{expr})
11524 If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11525 @var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
11526 or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
11527 This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
11528 conversion rules.
11529 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11530 @end deftypefn
11531
11532 @defmac TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION
11533 This macro determines whether to use the JCR section to register Java
11534 classes. By default, TARGET_USE_JCR_SECTION is defined to 1 if both
11535 SUPPORTS_WEAK and TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS are true, else 0.
11536 @end defmac
11537
11538 @defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11539 This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11540 NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11541 @end defmac
11542
11543 @defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11544 Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
11545 to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
11546 call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11547 and the associated definitions of those functions.
11548 @end defmac
11549
11550 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY (void)
11551 Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11552 necessary.
11553 @end deftypefn
11554
11555 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX (void)
11556 This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
11557 different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
11558 argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11559 is needed.
11560 @end deftypefn
11561
11562 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS (void)
11563 When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11564 arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
11565 stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11566 debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
11567 @code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11568 cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11569 to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11570 false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
11571 @end deftypefn
11572
11573 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11574 On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11575 a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
11576 is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11577 is computed from this register using immediate addition or
11578 subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
11579 the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11580 available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
11581 constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11582 down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11583 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11584 accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
11585 value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
11586 MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11587 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
11588 is zero, which disables this optimization.
11589 @end deftypevr
11590
11591 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_ASAN_SHADOW_OFFSET (void)
11592 Return the offset bitwise ored into shifted address to get corresponding
11593 Address Sanitizer shadow memory address. NULL if Address Sanitizer is not
11594 supported by the target.
11595 @end deftypefn
11596
11597 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_MEMMODEL_CHECK (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{val})
11598 Validate target specific memory model mask bits. When NULL no target specific
11599 memory model bits are allowed.
11600 @end deftypefn
11601
11602 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_ATOMIC_TEST_AND_SET_TRUEVAL
11603 This value should be set if the result written by @code{atomic_test_and_set} is not exactly 1, i.e. the @code{bool} @code{true}.
11604 @end deftypevr
11605
11606 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAS_IFUNC_P (void)
11607 It returns true if the target supports GNU indirect functions.
11608 The support includes the assembler, linker and dynamic linker.
11609 The default value of this hook is based on target's libc.
11610 @end deftypefn
11611
11612 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_ATOMIC_ALIGN_FOR_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode})
11613 If defined, this function returns an appropriate alignment in bits for an atomic object of machine_mode @var{mode}. If 0 is returned then the default alignment for the specified mode is used.
11614 @end deftypefn
11615
11616 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ATOMIC_ASSIGN_EXPAND_FENV (tree *@var{hold}, tree *@var{clear}, tree *@var{update})
11617 ISO C11 requires atomic compound assignments that may raise floating-point exceptions to raise exceptions corresponding to the arithmetic operation whose result was successfully stored in a compare-and-exchange sequence. This requires code equivalent to calls to @code{feholdexcept}, @code{feclearexcept} and @code{feupdateenv} to be generated at appropriate points in the compare-and-exchange sequence. This hook should set @code{*@var{hold}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feholdexcept}, @code{*@var{clear}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feclearexcept} and @code{*@var{update}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feupdateenv}. The three expressions are @code{NULL_TREE} on entry to the hook and may be left as @code{NULL_TREE} if no code is required in a particular place. The default implementation leaves all three expressions as @code{NULL_TREE}. The @code{__atomic_feraiseexcept} function from @code{libatomic} may be of use as part of the code generated in @code{*@var{update}}.
11618 @end deftypefn
11619
11620 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_RECORD_OFFLOAD_SYMBOL (tree)
11621 Used when offloaded functions are seen in the compilation unit and no named
11622 sections are available. It is called once for each symbol that must be
11623 recorded in the offload function and variable table.
11624 @end deftypefn
11625
11626 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {char *} TARGET_OFFLOAD_OPTIONS (void)
11627 Used when writing out the list of options into an LTO file. It should
11628 translate any relevant target-specific options (such as the ABI in use)
11629 into one of the @option{-foffload} options that exist as a common interface
11630 to express such options. It should return a string containing these options,
11631 separated by spaces, which the caller will free.
11632
11633 @end deftypefn
11634
11635 @defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT
11636
11637 On older ports, large integers are stored in @code{CONST_DOUBLE} rtl
11638 objects. Newer ports define @code{TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT} to be nonzero
11639 to indicate that large integers are stored in
11640 @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} rtl objects. The @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} allows
11641 very large integer constants to be represented. @code{CONST_DOUBLE}
11642 is limited to twice the size of the host's @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}
11643 representation.
11644
11645 Converting a port mostly requires looking for the places where
11646 @code{CONST_DOUBLE}s are used with @code{VOIDmode} and replacing that
11647 code with code that accesses @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}s. @samp{"grep -i
11648 const_double"} at the port level gets you to 95% of the changes that
11649 need to be made. There are a few places that require a deeper look.
11650
11651 @itemize @bullet
11652 @item
11653 There is no equivalent to @code{hval} and @code{lval} for
11654 @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}s. This would be difficult to express in the md
11655 language since there are a variable number of elements.
11656
11657 Most ports only check that @code{hval} is either 0 or -1 to see if the
11658 value is small. As mentioned above, this will no longer be necessary
11659 since small constants are always @code{CONST_INT}. Of course there
11660 are still a few exceptions, the alpha's constraint used by the zap
11661 instruction certainly requires careful examination by C code.
11662 However, all the current code does is pass the hval and lval to C
11663 code, so evolving the c code to look at the @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} is
11664 not really a large change.
11665
11666 @item
11667 Because there is no standard template that ports use to materialize
11668 constants, there is likely to be some futzing that is unique to each
11669 port in this code.
11670
11671 @item
11672 The rtx costs may have to be adjusted to properly account for larger
11673 constants that are represented as @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}.
11674 @end itemize
11675
11676 All and all it does not take long to convert ports that the
11677 maintainer is familiar with.
11678
11679 @end defmac